* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project
Download An empirical study on the factors influencing international marketing
Market penetration wikipedia , lookup
Dumping (pricing policy) wikipedia , lookup
Marketing communications wikipedia , lookup
Market segmentation wikipedia , lookup
First-mover advantage wikipedia , lookup
Field research wikipedia , lookup
Factor analysis wikipedia , lookup
Perfect competition wikipedia , lookup
Ambush marketing wikipedia , lookup
Multi-level marketing wikipedia , lookup
Darknet market wikipedia , lookup
Digital marketing wikipedia , lookup
Youth marketing wikipedia , lookup
Guerrilla marketing wikipedia , lookup
Marketing channel wikipedia , lookup
Target audience wikipedia , lookup
Viral marketing wikipedia , lookup
Segmenting-targeting-positioning wikipedia , lookup
Direct marketing wikipedia , lookup
Bayesian inference in marketing wikipedia , lookup
Neuromarketing wikipedia , lookup
Sensory branding wikipedia , lookup
Integrated marketing communications wikipedia , lookup
Target market wikipedia , lookup
Street marketing wikipedia , lookup
Green marketing wikipedia , lookup
Product planning wikipedia , lookup
Advertising campaign wikipedia , lookup
Marketing plan wikipedia , lookup
Marketing mix modeling wikipedia , lookup
Multicultural marketing wikipedia , lookup
Marketing research wikipedia , lookup
Southern Cross University ePublications@SCU Theses 2011 An empirical study on the factors influencing international marketing strategy development among successful exporters in Australia Ricky Yue-Mun Tang Southern Cross University Publication details Tang, R 2011, 'An empirical study on the factors influencing international marketing strategy development among successful exporters in Australia', DBA thesis, Southern Cross University, Lismore, NSW. Copyright R Tang 2011 ePublications@SCU is an electronic repository administered by Southern Cross University Library. Its goal is to capture and preserve the intellectual output of Southern Cross University authors and researchers, and to increase visibility and impact through open access to researchers around the world. For further information please contact [email protected]. AN EMPIRICAL STUDY ON THE FACTORS INFLUENCING INTERNATIONAL MARKETING STRATEGY DEVELOPMENT AMONG SUCCESSFUL EXPORTERS IN AUSTRALIA Ricky Yue-Mun Tang BBus (Financial Planning) with Distinction MBus (General Management & Marketing) A thesis submitted to the Graduate College of Management, Southern Cross University, Australia for partial fulfilment of the requirement for the degree of Doctor of Business Administration June 2011 DECLARATION OF ORIGINALITY I certify that the substance of this thesis has not been previously submitted for any degree at this or any other university. Also, I certify that to the best of my knowledge any help received in preparing this work and all sources used, have been acknowledged in this thesis. Ricky Yue-Mun Tang 26th June 2011 ii ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS For me to complete this study, I like to express my gratitude to the many individuals and organisations whose contributions are greatly acknowledged and appreciated. I would like to thank my principal supervisor Dr. Margo Poole for her excellent supervision. Her guidance and constructive criticism, quick response to problems and encouragement during the entire period of the study, together with the careful reading of the drafts of my dissertation, is sincerely acknowledged. Without her close guidance it would have been never possible to complete this research project within the time frame it has been completed. To Associate Professor Peter Miller, Associate Professor Shankar Sankaran, Dr. Carmen Cox and Dr. Don McMurray, I wish to express my sincere thanks for their valuable insights, support and encouragement in enhancing this study, particularly in their advices during the pre-testing of the survey questionnaire. I also like to thank those organisations and their managers who participated either in the qualitative or the quantitative parts of this research. This includes all the participants of the qualitative research for their valuable time in the rather lengthy interviews and the participants of the quantitative research in responding to the survey by completing the questionnaire. Special thanks to all my colleagues and professors, particularly those who attended the doctoral symposium that I presented on the research, for their interest, encouragement and valuable suggestions. Finally, I thank my wife Susan, for her continual support and encouragement during the entire period of the study. iii ABSTRACT The development of international marketing strategy is fundamental to the success of any business attempting to market their products and/or services overseas. There are many factors, both internal and external that impact on the decisions in the development of international marketing strategy. This research will examine the international marketing strategy practices of successful Australian exporters; investigate what factors these businesses consider and how these factors are related to the effectiveness of the strategy development decisions. Hence, the objective of this study is to explore the research problem relating to determining the factors considered by Australian successful exporters in developing their international marketing strategies and the relationship, if any, between the strategic developmental decisions and a range of context variables. The findings of this research will benefit both the academic and practitioner arena, contributing to a better and improved understanding of the factors influencing the development of international marketing strategies that would lead to an increase in Australia’s successful exports to overseas markets. The target population selected for this study were all successful Australian exporters who were either finalists or winners of the various categories of the Australian Export Awards for the five years from 2003 to 2007. This study was carried out solely in Australia from January 2007 to February 2010. The mixed methods research methodology employed in this study includes qualitative methods through in-depth interviews in the exploratory iv research stage and quantitative methods using an online survey questionnaire in the descriptive and causal research stage to test the hypotheses developed from the literature review. From the literature review carried out, several factors were found to have an impact on the decisions for the development of international marketing strategy. These include: market and industry factors in both domestic and foreign markets, the firm’s internal factors, foreign environmental factors and public and private support networks in the foreign markets. Thus, four hypotheses were developed based on these factors to be tested in the descriptive and explanatory research. These factors were further validated in the qualitative study. Subsequently, an online survey instrument in the form of a questionnaire was designed with all of these factors as variables to be emailed to a sample of respondents selected randomly from the target population. The collected data was screened, cleaned and several statistical tests were performed using SPSS version 14.0 for Windows software to analyse the data. However, due to the lack of statistically significant results from the analysis of the survey data, the four hypotheses were not supported. It is believed that this study is one of the few undertaken to examine the factors influencing the development of international marketing strategy of Australian exporters. It is hoped that future research will replicate this study in other countries. Such studies will not only substantiate this research, but also offer new insights into understanding the factors influencing the decisions in the development of an international marketing strategy on a global basis. v Key Words: International Marketing Strategy – Strategy Development Process and Factors – International Marketing – Strategic Marketing – Strategic Management – Australian Exporters vi TABLE OF CONTENTS DECLARATION OF ORIGINALITY ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS ABSTRACT TABLE OF CONTENTS LIST OF TABLES LIST OF FIGURES ABBREVIATIONS II III IV VII X XI XII 1 INTRODUCTION 1.1 Background to the Research 1.2 Research Problem, Questions and Hypotheses 1.3 Justification for the Research 1.4 Methodology 1.5 Outline of the Thesis 1.6 Definitions 1.7 Limitations and Delimitations 1.8 Conclusion 2 2 5 7 9 10 13 14 15 2 LITERATURE REVIEW 2.1 Introduction 2.2 Review of Parent and Immediate Disciplines 2.2.1 International Trade Theories 2.2.1.1 Comparative Advantage Theory 2.2.1.2 Product Life Cycle Theory 2.2.1.3 Production Sharing Theory 2.2.1.4 Internalisation Theory 2.2.2 Globalisation 2.2.3 Management Decision Making Models 2.2.3.1 The Rational Model 2.2.3.2 The Bounded Rationality Model 2.2.3.3 The Political Model 2.2.3.4 The Process Model 2.2.4 Strategic Management 2.2.4.1 Strategy Development Process 2.2.5 Marketing Strategy 2.2.6 International Marketing 2.2.7 International Marketing Strategy 2.2.7.1 Factors Influencing the IMS Development Process 2.3 Hypotheses Developed from the Literature 2.4 Conclusion 17 17 18 19 20 25 27 28 30 34 38 41 43 44 46 54 60 66 70 82 90 93 vii 3 3.1 3.2 3.3 RESEARCH DESIGN AND METHODOLOGY Introduction Justification for the Paradigm and Methodology Research Design 3.3.1 Qualitative Methodology 3.3.1.1 Qualitative Research Objectives Statement 3.3.1.2 Qualitative Research Sampling 3.3.1.3 The Qualitative Interview 3.3.1.4 Rigour of the Qualitative Research 3.3.1.5 Data Management and Analysis 3.3.2 Quantitative Methodology 3.3.2.1 Quantitative Research Objectives Statement 3.3.2.2 Quantitative Research Sampling 3.3.2.3 Data Collection 3.3.2.4 Questionnaire Design 3.3.2.4.1 Wording and Survey Items 3.3.2.4.2 Measurement Scales 3.3.2.4.3 General Appearance 3.3.2.5 Questionnaire Pre-testing 3.3.2.6 Pilot Study 3.3.2.7 Questionnaire Administration 3.3.2.8 Data Management and Analysis 3.3.2.9 Limitations of the Quantitative Methodology 3.4 Ethical Considerations 3.5 Conclusion 96 96 96 100 104 106 106 110 112 113 116 117 118 123 127 129 131 135 136 137 138 139 147 149 151 4 DATA ANALYSIS AND RESEARCH FINDINGS 4.1 Introduction 4.2 Qualitative Data Analysis 4.2.1 Profile of Interview Participants 4.2.2 Data Reduction and Display 4.2.3 Qualitative Data Findings 4.3 Quantitative Data Analysis 4.3.1 Classification of Data 4.3.2 Preliminary Analysis of Data 4.3.2.1 Data Screening and Entry 4.3.2.2 Composite Variables 4.3.2.3 Factor Analysis 4.3.2.4 Correlation Analysis 4.3.2.5 Univariate and Multivariate Outliers 4.3.2.6 Normality of Distribution 4.3.2.7 Descriptive Analysis of Data 4.3.3 Common Method Variance 4.3.4 Reliability and Validity 4.3.4.1 Reliability 4.3.4.2 Validity 4.3.5 Testing of Research Hypotheses 4.3.6 Non-Parametric Analysis 4.4 Summary of Research Findings 4.5 Conclusion 154 154 155 157 158 162 165 165 170 170 171 171 175 176 177 179 180 181 182 183 184 189 191 192 viii 5 CONCLUSIONS AND IMPLICATIONS 5.1 Introduction 5.2 Discussion of Hypotheses Underpinning the Research Questions 5.2.1 Review and Conclusion for Hypothesis One 5.2.1.1 Market and Industry Factors in Domestic Markets 5.2.1.2 Market and Industry Factors in Foreign Markets 5.2.2 Review and Conclusion for Hypothesis Two 5.2.3 Review and Conclusion for Hypothesis Three 5.2.4 Review and Conclusion for Hypothesis Four 5.3 Conclusions from the Research Findings Regarding the Research Questions 5.4 Contributions of This Research 5.4.1 Implications for Theory 5.4.2 Implications for Policy and Practice 5.5 Limitations of this Research 5.6 Future Research 5.7 Conclusion 196 196 196 199 200 202 206 208 212 REFERENCES 226 APPENDICES Appendix 1: Australian Export Awards (2007) Selection Criteria Appendix 2: Semi-structured Interview Guide Appendix 3: Sample Size Decision Table Appendix 4: Online Survey Questionnaire Appendix 5: Information Sheet for Survey Appendix 6: Introductory email to the Survey Appendix 7: Follow-up email to the Cover Letter Appendix 8: Email reminder to the Survey Appendix 9: Second Email Reminder Appendix 10: SPSS Generated Outputs 250 250 252 254 255 263 265 266 267 268 269 ix 214 216 217 219 220 221 223 LIST OF TABLES Table 2.1: Interdisciplinary Models of Decision-making ................................. 37 Table 2.2: Characteristics of Six Dimensions of Strategy Development ........ 57 Table 2.3: Growth Strategies - Products and Markets ................................... 64 Table 2.4: Factors to Consider in the Development of IMS............................. 90 Table 2.5: Summary of the Factors’ Effect on IMS Development Decisions ... 94 Table 3.1: Types of Business Research ..................................................... 101 Table 3.2: Qualitative Purposeful Sampling Strategies ................................ 107 Table 3.3: The Semi-structured Interview Approach.................................... 111 Table 3.4: Stages in Selection of a Sample ................................................. 118 Table 3.5: Advantages and Disadvantages of Typical Survey Methods ...... 124 Table 3.6: Types of Statistical Tests ............................................................ 143 Table 4.1: Profile of Interview Participants .................................................. 158 Table 4.2: In-depth Interviews Data Display ................................................ 159 Table 4.3: Response Rate of the Survey ..................................................... 166 Table 4.4: Distribution of Respondents by Industry Category ...................... 167 Table 4.5: Distribution of Respondent Firms by their Annual International Turnover ...................................................................................................... 167 Table 4.6: Distribution of Respondent Firms by Ownership Types .............. 168 Table 4.7: Distribution of Respondent Firms by Length of International Experience................................................................................................... 168 Table 4.8: Distribution of Respondent Firms Product/services by Number of Countries Marketed ..................................................................................... 169 Table 4.9: Distribution of Respondents by Mode of Market Entry ................ 169 Table 4.10: Formation of Composite Variables............................................ 171 Table 4.11: KMO MSA and Bartlett's Test of Sphericity .............................. 173 Table 4.12: Factor Analysis Eigenvalues and Component Loadings ........... 174 Table 4.13: Skewness and Kurtosis ............................................................ 178 Table 4.14: Descriptive Statistics of Data .................................................... 179 Table 4.15: Cronbach’s alpha Value of Composite Variables ...................... 182 Table 4.16: Multiple Linear Regression Findings ......................................... 188 Table 4.17: Correlation between independent and dependent variables ..... 190 Table 4.18: Demographics of Respondents ................................................ 191 Table 4.19: Summary of Hypotheses Testing .............................................. 192 x LIST OF FIGURES Figure 1.1: Structure of the Thesis ................................................................ 11 Figure 2.1: Relationship of Parent and Immediate Disciplines ...................... 19 Figure 2.2: The Rational Decision-making Model .......................................... 39 Figure 2.3: Resources, Capabilities and the Creation of Value ..................... 51 Figure 2.4: Key Elements of Marketing Strategy ............................................ 62 Figure 2.5: The Role of Marketing in the Organisation .................................. 67 Figure 2.6: The International Marketing Strategy Process .............................. 72 Figure 2.7: Generic International Marketing Strategies ................................. 75 Figure 2.8: Factors Influencing the Development of International Marketing Strategy ......................................................................................................... 83 Figure 2.9: Model of the Hypotheses Relating to the Development of International Marketing Strategy .................................................................... 92 Figure 3.1: Outline of the Research Design ................................................. 101 Figure 3.2: Literature Review and Research Methodologies Relationship .. 104 Figure 3.3: The Theory-before-Research Model.......................................... 105 Figure 3.4: In-depth Interviews by Industry Type and Firm Size .................. 109 Figure 3.5: An Interactive Model of Qualitative Data Analysis ..................... 115 Figure 3.6: The Four Phases of the Quantitative Research Process ............ 116 Figure 3.7: Principles of Questionnaire Design............................................. 128 Figure 3.8: Overview of the Stages in Quantitative Data Analysis ............... 140 xi ABBREVIATIONS AEAs Australian Export Awards ANOVA Analysis of Variance A$ Australian Dollar AUD Australian Dollar AUSTRADE Australian Trade Commission CEO Chief Executive Officer DFAT Department of Foreign Affairs and Trade, Australia EEC European Economic Communities EU European Union EXEF Foreign Environmental Factors FINF Firm’s Internal Factors GDP Gross Domestic Product GNP Gross National Product GMS Global Marketing Strategy HREC Human Research Ethics Committee ICT Information and Communication Technology IFDM Industry Factors in Domestic Markets IFFM Industry Factors in Foreign Markets IMS International Marketing Strategy IMSD International Marketing Strategy Development Decisions Effectiveness KMO Kaiser-Meyer-Olkin xii ABBREVIATIONS LDCs Less Developed Countries MFDM Market Factors in Domestic Markets MFFM Market Factors in Foreign Markets MLR Multiple Linear Regression MNCs Multi-National Corporations MSA Measure of Sampling Adequacy PDC Primary Data Collection PLC Product Life Cycle R&D Research and Development ROI Return on Investment SCU Southern Cross University, Australia SMEs Small and Medium Sized Enterprises SNFF Support Networks Factors in Foreign Markets SPSS Statistical Package for the Social Sciences, Quantitative Data Analysis Software US United States of America xiii CHAPTER ONE Introduction Chapter 1 Introduction 1.1 Background to the Research Chapter 2 Literature Review 1.2 Research Problem, Questions and Hypotheses Chapter 3 Research Design and Methodology 1.3 Justification for the Research Chapter 4 Data Analysis and Research Findings 1.4 Methodology Chapter 5 Conclusions and Implications 1.5 Outline of the Thesis 1.6 Definitions 1.7 Limitations and Delimitations 1.8 Conclusion 1 AN EMPIRICAL STUDY ON THE FACTORS INFLUENCING INTERNATIONAL MARKETING STRATEGY DEVELOPMENT AMONG SUCCESSFUL EXPORTERS IN AUSTRALIA 1 INTRODUCTION 1.1 Background to the Research During the last four decades, international markets have undergone tremendous changes with far reaching implications. Global political, social and economic trends during this time have created major business opportunities and challenges for international marketers. A continuous worldwide trend towards economic liberalisation and the rise of new economies are augmenting such opportunities and challenges. Hence, international marketing is playing a vital role in world economic activities and its importance is expected to grow further as markets become more globalised (Harcourt 2007). In Australia, exports of goods and services totalling AUD$223 billion are a significant component of the Australian economy and comprised around 23.7 percent of GDP in 2008 (Australia Department of Foreign Affairs and Trade 2009). While exports exhibited strong growth in the period 1980 – 2001, accounting for nearly one-third of GDP growth, in the five years to 2007 they accounted for a little more than one-eighth of GDP growth (Australian Department of Foreign Affairs and Trade 2008). Correspondingly, Australia’s 2 total export revenues grew at an annual average rate of only 6.6 percent in the period 2001 - 2007, compared with 9.4 percent in the period 19832001(Australian Department of Foreign Affairs and Trade 2008). Thus, in recent years there has been deterioration in the performance of Australian exports and one would argue that this issue needs to be explored and addressed by the export communities, including the Australian government, international marketers and academicians. As part of the solution to address the declining export performance, and to meet the challenges and opportunities of the rapidly globalising markets, Australia needs to improve its international competitiveness by increasing the quality of management skills and knowledge in international marketing; and bolstering research, development and innovation. However, to succeed in global markets, improving Australia’s international competitiveness will be imperative and streamlining development of appropriate international marketing strategy by exporters will, in part, contribute to this improvement in their international competiveness. The decisions about which marketing strategies to employ, the selection of the foreign market(s) to enter (Rahman 2001; 2006) and how to enter these market(s) (Malhotra et al. 2003) are recognised as key aspects in exporting to international markets (Fletcher & Brown 2005). There are many international marketing strategies and there are many ways to enter overseas markets. Hence, no one firm is likely to have the resources to develop profitable international businesses based on all of these marketing strategies. Therefore, developing the right international marketing strategy is not only vital for businesses’ success, but could also raise 3 Australia’s international competiveness in the global marketplace and increase its export performance. Moreover, there appears to be a strong association between international marketing strategy and export performance measures. This is evidenced by the numerous research carried out in this area with the conclusion that the implementation of a well-developed international marketing strategy can indeed determine export success, as the majority of the marketing strategy variables were significantly associated with overall export performance (Aaby & Slater 1989; Cooper & Kleinschmidt 1985; Crespy et al. 1993; Julian & Ahmed 2005; Koh 1991; Lages 2000; Lages & Montgomery 2004; Leonidou et al. 2002; Louter et al. 1991; Lu & Julian 2008; Ogunmokun & Ng 2004; Thirkell & Ramadhani 1998; Zou & Stan 1998). The importance and the need for systematic development and implementation of appropriate international marketing strategies has been stressed by many researchers (Bennett & Blythe 2002; Bradley 2005; Doole & Lowe 2008; Fifield & Lewis 1998), and several models on the influencing factors in the development of international marketing strategies has been prescribed (Bradley 2005; Doole & Lowe 2008; Fifield & Lewis 1998). However, not many of these models have been empirically tested. Furthermore, to date, there has been limited research carried out within Australia on this particular issue. 4 1.2 Research Problem, Questions and Hypotheses This study is designed to address the following research problem: To be successful, Australian exporters need to determine the key factors influencing the development of their international marketing strategies and the relationship, if any, between the strategic developmental decisions and a range of contextual variables. Accordingly, the key questions this research will address are: Q1 - What are the key factors influencing the development of international marketing strategies among successful Australian exporters? Q2 - Are the key factors influencing the development of international marketing strategies among successful Australian exporters related to the effectiveness of the strategy development decisions? Following from this, the following hypotheses, developed from the literature review in Chapter Two, are investigated in this research: Hypothesis 1: The consideration of market and industry factors in both domestic and foreign markets are positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. This is separated into four sub-hypotheses, each of which represents a market or industry factor in both domestic and foreign markets as follows: 5 Hypothesis 1a: The consideration of market factors in domestic markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 1b: The consideration of industry factors in domestic markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 1c: The consideration of market factors in foreign markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 1d: The consideration of industry factors in foreign markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 2: The consideration of the firm's internal factors is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 3: The consideration of foreign environmental factors is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 4: The consideration of public and private support networks in foreign markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. 6 1.3 Justification for the Research The global market is large, complex and diverse (Keegan & Green 2007). To successfully market products and services to these international markets, the development of appropriate international marketing strategies play a major role in the success or failure of the firm’s endeavour. However, many mistakes are made by international marketers and there exists a welldeveloped literature of market failures committed abroad by international marketers (Dalgic & Heijblom 1996; Hartley 2004; Knight 1995; White 2002). While many go unpublicised, such mistakes occur frequently in international marketing (Dalgic & Heijblom 1996). Mistakes relating to international marketing strategy occur through inadequate or inappropriate development and implementation of international marketing strategies. The outcomes are almost always more expensive than the costs associated with systematic analysis and the development and implementation of appropriate international marketing strategies that would have prevented their occurrence (White 2002). Hence, the international firm needs to systematically evaluate its international marketing strategy on a regular basis to confirm that the firm’s assets are directed toward markets with the best returns and opportunities. However, because the resources of a firm are limited, they must be allocated in such a way as to maximise potential success across the markets served (Bradley 2005; Doole & Lowe 2008). This development process encourages the firm to evaluate information about market size, competition, regulations, and environmental factors that will form the basis for the development of an international marketing strategy. 7 The goal of this process is twofold: firms want to minimise the mistakes of (1) ignoring markets that offer viable opportunities for the firm's products and/or services, and (2) wasting time on markets that offer little or no potential (Root 1998). Both of these errors could be costly for international marketers. Accordingly, it is important that international marketers should have some pre-set decision variables to help them develop their international marketing strategies as well as understand the key factors that influence the effectiveness of the development decisions of their strategy. There are a range of decision variables and models in international marketing strategy literature (Bradley 2005; Doole & Lowe 2008; Fifield & Lewis 1998); however the formulation of theoretical constructs has not been followed by systematic empirical testing of these constructs in order that these variables become integrated into the general body of international marketing strategy theory. Although there has been substantial research on export market performance of Australian international businesses related to export / international marketing strategies (Julian & Ahmed 2005; Julian & O'Cass 2004; Lu & Julian 2008; O'Cass & Julian 2003; Ogunmokun & Ng 2004; Ogunmokun & Wong 2004), reported research on the development process of international marketing strategy among Australian exporters has been minimal. As such, by empirical testing of the variables influencing the development process of international marketing strategy among successful exporters in Australia, this research is a step towards filling that gap. Hence, this study represents one of the few empirical investigations of the international strategy development process in Australia. As such, it has both academic and practical contributions. From an academic perspective, 8 this research, (1) successfully integrates and applies existing knowledge in decision-making theories, trade theories, strategic management theories, marketing strategy theories and international marketing theories, (2) identifies and establishes the key factors related to the development process of international marketing strategy, (3) identifies and tests specific constructs for making international marketing strategy development decisions, and develops measurement scales for those constructs, and (4) integrates qualitative and quantitative research methodologies to give greater insight into the research question. From both policy and practical perspectives, this research will be: (1) useful to firms of different sizes, (2) provide guidance to government agencies such as Austrade, that offer information and advice to organisations planning to export, and (3) has the potential to be the basis of a decision support system for the development of an organisation's international marketing strategy. 1.4 Methodology The mixed methods research methodology employed in this study integrates both qualitative and quantitative methods. Qualitative and quantitative research differ in many ways, but they complement each other (Neuman 2006). Furthermore, the use of multiple methods or triangulation reflects an attempt to secure an in-depth understanding of the phenomenon in question (Creswell & Plano Clark 2007). Because different lenses or perspectives result from the use of different methods, often more than one method may be used within a project so the researcher can gain a more holistic view of the 9 setting (Morse 1994). The justification for this mixed methodology is discussed in Section 3.2. In-depth interviews were used in the exploratory stage of the research to identify and validate the constructs of theories on the development of international marketing strategy that arose from the literature review as well as contributing input for specific constructs of international marketing strategy development in the design of the survey instrument. Several factors were found to have an impact on the decisions developed in the literature review. These included market and industry factors in both domestic and foreign markets, the firm’s internal factors, foreign environmental factors, and public and private support networks in the foreign markets. Following these factors, four hypotheses were developed from the literature review to be tested in the descriptive and explanatory (causal) stage of the research through an online web-based survey. Details of the qualitative research procedures are discussed in Section 3.3.1 and the quantitative research procedures in Section 3.3.2. 1.5 Outline of the Thesis This section provides an overall outline of the thesis structure and an explanation of the appropriateness of this structure. This thesis was constructed following the outline of Perry’s (1998) five chapters thesis model, which in the main, conforms to that generally undertaken for dissertations within the discipline of marketing (Perry 1998) and is presented in Figure 1.1 on the next page. 10 Figure 1.: Structure of the Thesis Body of Knowledge Chapter 2 Literature Review - Chapter 5 Conclusions and Implications Justification of the research problem and research gap - Research problem solved Implications and contributions Chapter 1 Introduction - The research problem Overview of the research Chapter 3 Research Methodology - Chapter 4 Data Analysis Justification of the research paradigm Detailed description and justification of the research process - Analysis of responses Testing of relationships Research Project Source: Adapted from Perry (1998) Perry (1998) described the thesis as requiring a structure that unifies it around one key idea or issue. The key issue in this dissertation is the research problem, introduced in Section 1.2: To determine the key factors considered by successful Australian exporters in developing their international marketing strategies and the relationship, if any, between the strategic developmental decisions and a range of contextual variables. Chapter One provides the introduction, describes the background to the research and sets the scene for the thesis by providing an overview of the dissertation. It identifies the research problem to be addressed and states the 11 research questions and hypotheses. It also provides both theoretical and practical justification for the research to be undertaken, as well as giving an overview of the methodology and analytical approach adopted. Finally, the definitions and limitations of the study are discussed, and structure of the dissertation is explained. Chapter Two presents a review of the literature related to the factors influencing the development of international marketing strategy. It also draws considerably from the literature in developing and justifying the research problem, confirming the research questions and formulating the hypotheses. This examination of the relevant literature is used to build the theoretical foundation of the thesis. Chapter Three presents the methodology used to undertake the study and covers, in detail, the research process followed in this study. Both qualitative and quantitative research methodologies are discussed and justified. Issues relating to the development, refinement and administration of the data collection instrument are then explored. Finally, anticipated analytical procedures are examined and ethical considerations are discussed. Chapter Four discusses the analysis of both qualitative and quantitative data and addresses the hypotheses developed in Chapter Two. The profile of respondents is reviewed and preliminary analysis is undertaken. Factor analysis is undertaken and the data are screened to assess reliability and validity. Finally, the results of the analysis relating to the hypotheses are presented. Chapter Five consists of a detailed discussion in which the findings of the study are evaluated by considering the contribution to theory, implications 12 in both theoretical and practical terms, as well as limitations and implications for further research in light of the findings. 1.6 Definitions Definitions used by researchers may be specific to a particular study and are not necessarily applicable to other studies. The definitions provided here clarify the meanings of significant terms used in this dissertation. They are listed in alphabetical order. Australian Government Agencies refer to the Federal government agencies like Austrade, the Department of Foreign Affairs and Trade offices as well as states and territories trade and investment offices. International Marketing Strategy Development refers to a complex set of activities, decisions, processes and routines involved in the design of international marketing plans. International Marketing Strategy Development Decisions Effectiveness refers to the measure of the effectiveness of those decisions made during the development of a company’s international marketing strategies that would impact on the organisation’s export success in overseas markets. Successful Exporters refer to finalists and winners in the various categories of the annual Australian Export Awards. The selection criterion for the Australian Export Awards is in Appendix 1. 13 1.7 Limitations and Delimitations Australia is a small, open economy and a relatively minor player internationally with less than two percent share of the world GDP and less than one percent share of the annual international trade in 2007 (World Trade Organization 2008). As this research has been carried out in Australia only, the findings of this research may not be considered as an international phenomenon. To determine international validity, these tests need to be replicated with similar firms in other countries. Another limitation of this research is that the findings of the variables are reflective of the international marketing strategy development behaviour of successful exporters in Australia. This research identifies the factors that affect the development process of international marketing strategy and the measurement scales of each of those factors. It does not take into consideration the individual weighting that may be assigned by each firm to those factors and its measurement scales. Also, time may be a factor in the development and implementation of international marketing strategy. An international marketing strategy that has the potential for a particular product/service today may not continue to have the same potential in a few years hence. Similarly, an international marketing strategy that is not appropriate today may, in the future, hold greater potential. This research does not examine this time factor and its importance in the development of international marketing strategy. Finally, the scope of this research is also limited by the research questions this study addresses. All the above stated limitations of this study are beyond the scope of the research questions. Further, it is inappropriate to 14 try to investigate all the important diverse issues related to a broad topic like international marketing strategy in one research project. 1.8 Conclusion This introductory chapter has set the stage for the study. In this chapter the research problem, research questions and hypotheses have been introduced and the need for this research justified. The methodology used in this research has also be briefly described and justified. Definitions of the key terms have been presented, limitations described, and the dissertation has been outlined. With this foundation, the dissertation will now proceed to give a detailed description of the research. In the next chapter, the relevant literature that sets the foundation of the study will be reviewed and specific research hypotheses underpinning the research questions will be developed. 15 CHAPTER TWO Literature Review Chapter 1 Introduction Chapter 2 Literature Review 2.1 Introduction Chapter 3 Research Design and Methodology 2.2 Review of Parent and Immediate Disciplines Chapter 4 Data Analysis and Research Findings 2.3 Hypotheses developed from the Literature Chapter 5 Conclusions and Implications 2.4 Conclusion 16 2 LITERATURE REVIEW 2.1 Introduction In the first chapter, the overview of this thesis was addressed. In this chapter, a review of the literature from several key business disciplines will build the theoretical foundation of this study. The focus of this review is to draw and consolidate knowledge from different yet related literature in an effort to synthesise a general model of successful international marketers' strategy development behaviour; and to establish to what extent existing models that have been proposed incorporate these theories in explaining the firm's international marketing strategy development process. Theories from several disciplines will be examined. Research hypotheses will be drawn from these different related areas which are argued to contribute to our knowledge of the development process of international marketing strategies. Firstly, the structure and map of the chapter sections are outlined. Following this, the three parent disciplines of this research, namely International Trade (Section 2.2.1) and Globalisation (Section 2.2.2); Management Decision Making (Section 2.2.3); and Strategic Management (Section 2.2.4) are then considered. These parent disciplines provide the background for the immediate disciplines, which focus on Marketing Strategy (Section 2.2.5), and International Marketing (Section 2.2.6) as well as the key factors affecting the development process of international marketing strategy (Section 2.2.7) in organisations. 17 Finally, from the review of this literature, four hypotheses are developed to address the research questions on what are the key factors influencing the development of international marketing strategies among successful Australian exporters and how are those factors related to the effectiveness of the strategy development decisions? As important insights into the development processes of international marketing strategy can be gained from examining theories and ongoing research in the fields of international marketing, strategic management, marketing strategy, international trade and globalisation, and management decision making, the development processes of international marketing strategy models proposed in the literature will be examined within this broader context to identify any factors not currently being accounted for. 2.2 Review of Parent and Immediate Disciplines Given the large amount of disciplinary literature that relates in some way to this research, only the critical antecedents have been examined. According to Phillips and Pugh (1987) a literature review should examine disciplines immediate to the research problem, and also demonstrate a familiarity with relevant parent disciplines which they described as focus and background theories, respectively. Management decision making models, international trade and globalisation theories and strategic management theories are all parent disciplines of international marketing strategy. Whereas, international marketing and marketing strategy theories may be viewed as immediate 18 disciplines. Figure 2.1 shows the relationship of the disciplines that will be analysed in the subsequent sections of this chapter. Figure 2.: Relationship of Parent and Immediate Disciplines Management Decision Making International Marketing IMMEDIATE Marketing Strategy Strategic Management PARENT International Trade and Globalisation International Marketing Strategy Source: Developed for this research 2.2.1 International Trade Theories International trade theories have been used to explain why trade and investments take place. As affirmed by Waud et al. (1992, p.868) “Every country finds it advantageous to trade with other countries. In varying degrees, all economies are linked with one another by trade flows and financial networks which circle the globe”. Furthermore, the theories of international trade have been instrumental in establishing convincingly the gains to be made from international specialisation and trade (Ethier 1997; Frey 1986; Griffin & Pustay 2007; Kenen 2000; Krugman & Obstfield 2006; Markusen et al. 1995). 19 In general, trade occurs because nations have different resource endowments and technological capabilities (Markusen et al. 1995). Because of these differences, each nation can gain by specialising in those products that it produces efficiently, and by trading for those it produces inefficiently or cannot produce at all. In brief, international trade allows nations to increase the productivity of their resources through specialisation and to realise a higher standard of living than is possible in the absence of trade. These international trade theories, which explain why nations trade with each other, are related concepts to international marketing. These theories are aimed at understanding product flows between countries, either in the form of imports or exports. In this respect, international marketing and international trade are concerned with the same phenomenon (Jeannet & Hennessey 2004; Krugman & Obstfield 2006; Rivera-Batiz & Rivera-Batiz 1994; Sachs & Larrain 2001; Yarbough & Yarbough 2005). The international trade theories to be examined in relation to the international marketing strategy are: (1) the comparative advantage theory, (2) product life cycle theory, (3) production sharing theory, and (4) internalisation theory. 2.2.1.1 Comparative Advantage Theory The comparative advantage theory was developed by nineteenth-century British economist David Ricardo. It states that a country should produce and export those goods and services for which it is relatively more productive than are other countries, and import those goods and services for which other countries are relatively more productive than it is (Ricardo 1963). 20 Ricardo (1963) argued that trade could be beneficial on the basis of comparative advantage and not just absolute advantage. Even when a nation has absolute advantage in everything it produces, it will also have a greater advantage in some goods than others. By choosing to produce goods in which it has a greater advantage, the more efficient nation can allocate scarce resources more effectively. The output forgone or opportunity cost is less when resources are taken away from less advantaged goods and put to use in the production of more advantaged goods. When each country chooses to produce by specialising on the basis of lower opportunity cost, the resulting resource allocation would be in accordance with the principle of comparative advantage. Since economic efficiency among trading nations improves as a result of trade based on comparative advantage, countries would be better off in terms of total wealth after trade (Ricardo 1963). Another alternative theory of international trade traces the source of comparative advantage to the relative scarcity of the factors of production in different countries. Developed by two Swedish economists, Eli Hecksher (1949) and Bertil Ohlin (1933) and known as the Theory of relative factor endowments or Hecksher-Ohlin Theory, it states that a country will have a comparative advantage in producing products that intensively use resources (factors of production) it has in abundance (Heckscher & Ohlin 1991). According to the Hecksher-Ohlin Theory, factor endowments of resources and labour differ among nations. Thus, countries export goods that use their most abundant resources intensively and import the goods that require intensive use of their most scarce factors. However, some research 21 argues for the consideration of both innate and acquired assets (Krugman 1994; Porter 1990b). The Hecksher-Ohlin Theory suggests a strong relationship between potential international business transactions and a nation's endowments of the factors of production. Later on, Hirsch (1967) adds market size as a potential indicator. He emphasises the relationship between international trade, comparative costs, and a nation's market size; stating that countries that are likely targets for initial exports and sources of early manufacturing competition have similar domestic markets. Based on the above theories, advanced economies having similar climate and factor proportions should not trade with one another since there are no comparative advantages. However, much trade does occur among developed nations and thus there must be other variables in addition to factor endowments, which play a significant role in determining trade volume and practices. Porter (1990b) analysed over one hundred case studies of industries in ten leading developed nations, and developed the Theory of National Competitive Advantage which identified four major determinants of international competitiveness: (1) factor conditions – the nation’s position in factors of production, such as skilled labour or infrastructure, necessary to compete in a given industry; (2) demand conditions – the nature of home demand for the industry’s product or service; (3) related and supporting industries – the presence or absence in the nation of supplier industries and related industries that are internationally competitive; and (4) firm strategy, structure, and rivalry – the conditions in the nation governing how businesses 22 are created, organised and managed, and the nature of domestic rivalry. Also identified were chance events and government influences, which are deemed minor determinants (Porter 1990b). However, international trade theories are not without its limitations. In reality, international trade is far more complex than the limiting assumptions upon which the theories of international trade are based. A firm's costs are based not only on factor costs, such as wages and materials, but also on the volume of production (Ross et al. 2005). This pragmatic observation, which was first suggested by the Boston Consulting Group, is now widely known as the Experience Theory. Hence, even though a firm may be paying higher wages and experiencing other higher factor costs than it would encounter in other parts of the world, if it has a volume advantage over competitors, its net cost position may still be lower. Another limitation of classical trade theories is that they ignore product and marketing differentiation (Griffin & Pustay 2007). A firm's ability to compete in national or international markets is only partly determined by its cost position. Of great significance are the actual product and marketing differentiation and the effectiveness of the firm's customer offering in relation to competitive offerings. When several competitors practice undifferentiated marketing, the result is intense competition in the largest market or market segments and under-satisfaction of the smaller ones. Kuehn and Day (1962) called this tendency to chase the largest market the majority fallacy. The recognition of this fallacy had led firms, particularly in domestic marketing situations to increase their interest in entering smaller neglected markets or 23 market segments. Increasingly, firms are trying to find a match between their markets and their abilities. Also, trade theories are primarily concerned with commodities rather than with manufactured goods or value-added products (Griffin & Pustay 2007). They assume that all suppliers have identical products with similar quality and physical attributes. However, this practice of assuming product homogeneity is not likely to be made among those familiar with marketing. More often than not, products are endowed with psychological attributes. As such, brand name products are often promoted as having additional value based on psychological nuance (Kapferer 2004). A further shortcoming of classical trade theories is that the trade patterns as described in the theories are in reality frequently affected by trade restrictions. The direction of flow of trade, according to some critics of free trade, is no longer determined by a country's natural comparative advantage. Rather, a country can create relative advantage by relying on outsourcing and other trade barriers such as tariffs and quotas (Porter 1998). Therefore, protectionism can alter the trade patterns as described by trade theories. Despite these limitations, however, the theory of comparative advantage does demonstrate that trade between countries can lead to increases in world output and can be mutually beneficial to all nations of the world. 24 2.2.1.2 Product Life Cycle Theory The theory of comparative advantage is a classical explanation of world trade. In the 1960s, researchers Richard Vernon and Louis Wells, Jr. at the Harvard Business School offered a new explanation of international trade and investment patterns. The new approach uses the concept of product life cycle (PLC) in marketing and traces the roles of innovation, market expansion, comparative advantage, and strategic responses of global rivals in international production, trade and investment decisions (Vernon 1966). According to Richard Vernon’s theory, the international product life cycle consists of three stages: (1) new product, (2) maturing product, and (3) standardised product. In the first stage, the firm develops and introduces an innovative product in response to a perceived need in the domestic market, with production initially commencing in the country where its R&D occurred, typically a developed country. In next stage, demand for the product expands dramatically as consumers recognise its value and the innovating firm increases its production to satisfy domestic and foreign demand for the product. In the last stage, the market for the product stabilises. The product becomes more of a commodity, and firms are pressured to lower their manufacturing costs by shifting production to facilities in countries with lower labour costs. As a result, the product begins to be imported into the innovating firm’s home market. The 1960s also saw the development of a new set of theories of international trade around the basic concept of technological gap (Hirsch 1965; Hufbauer 1966; Posner 1961). Such theories analysed how product innovation in one country leads to cumulative technological advantages and to 25 trade advantages. The extent and duration of the trade advantages will depend on the extent of the cumulative advantages for the innovative firm, on the speed with which demand for the new product spreads, and on the speed with which other domestic and foreign firms start imitating the new product. The product life cycle (PLC) model, which is based on this concept, states that products go through the following four stages (Wells 1968): Phase 1: Innovating country export strength builds Phase 2: Foreign production starts Phase 3: Foreign production becomes competitive in export markets Phase 4: Import competition begins in domestic (innovating country) markets. The product life cycle theory of world trade holds that advanced countries like the United States (US) play the innovative role in product development. Later on, other relatively advanced countries take over the market position held by the innovative country (Darlin 1988). The secondstage countries would go through the same cycle as did the innovative country and, in turn, would lose their markets to the next group of countries, such as third world countries. Thus, a product initially produced in advanced countries would eventually be produced only in less developed countries, with the result that the innovating countries would meet the needs for that product through import from less developed countries (LDCs). This theory establishes that depending on what stage of a particular industry life cycle stage a country is in, it will show different levels of market attractiveness at different points of time. In other words, market attractiveness will be industry specific rather than only dependent on the overall size of the economy. 26 The PLC theory offered an explanation of the timing, the level, and the direction of exports and investments. The PLC theory also suggests various environmental factors that might be useful in the development of international marketing strategies. Vernon (1966) and Wells (1968) suggested that market size and level of economic development were important in explaining trade and investment patterns in the early and middle stages of the PLC, while factors of production costs are significant in explaining the role of developing countries in later stages. Some researchers have identified potential problems with this theory, including a US bias when it was first proposed, and that it is perhaps best used for consumer durables, synthetic materials and electronic products, rather than luxury goods and high-technology products (Grossman & Helpman 1989). Despite these problems, however, the PLC reasoning appears sound and it continues to be offered as an explanation of trade and investment patterns (Terpstra & Sarathy 2000). 2.2.1.3 Production Sharing Theory In the late 1970s, Peter Drucker (1977) introduced a new concept of international business and trade called Production Sharing. The theory of production sharing suggests that developed countries will turn to developing countries where the availability of labour is a major asset. Currently, production sharing seems to be quite prevalent, and growing at a rapid pace especially in the East Asian region (Gaulier et al. 2007; Ng & Yeats 1999). However, it is a new phenomenon for which there are no classical or neoclassical explanatory theories. 27 Production sharing is evidenced through transnational business integration with relationships made possible by technological and business forces (Drucker 1977). Production sharing offers both the developed and developing countries a chance to share their resources and strengths for mutual benefit. It also provides an explanation of why firms develop their international marketing strategy for certain countries even if these international markets are deemed unattractive through more traditional measures of size and growth. 2.2.1.4 Internalisation Theory One conceptualisation that has proved popular and successful with followers of the international business literature is the theory embracing internalisation. One of its contributors referred to the Theory of Internalisation as the modern theory of multinational enterprise (Rugman 1997). The internalisation theory provides an economic rationale for the existence of multi-national corporations (MNCs) and relies heavily on the concept of transaction costs when internationalising businesses. Multinational corporations often serve a market across national boundaries either by exporting from a production facility located in the country of the parent firm, or from a third country subsidiary or it can set up production facilities in the market itself. The sourcing decision rests mainly on the costs and benefits to the firm, taking into consideration industry specific factors (e.g. nature of the product), region specific factors (e.g. geographic location), nation specific factors (e.g. political climate), and firm specific factors (e.g. managerial ability to internalise) (Rugman 1997). 28 The internalisation theory primarily focuses on the motives and decision processes within the multinational firm, but the theory is not fully successful in explaining international production, partly because its efficiency approach restricts flexibility and applicability. Decisions on international production, whether related to the location or to the type of involvement, are strategic decisions and although efficiency elements may play a role, the strategic aspects are more likely to be prominent (Letto-Gillies 1994). Nevertheless, this theory supports the fact that international marketing strategy factors are industry and firm dependent, since it explains that international firm's marketing strategy, not only to service but also to source products to service other country markets. In summary, trade theories provide logical explanations about why nations trade with one another, but such theories are limited by their underlying assumptions. Most of the world's trade rules are based on a traditional model that assumes that (1) trade is bilateral, (2) the exporting country has a comparative advantage, (3) trade involves products originating primarily in the exporting country, and (4) competition primarily focuses on the importing country's market. However, today's realities are quite different. Firstly, trade is a multilateral process. Secondly, it is not easy to determine a country's comparative advantage, as evidenced by countries that often export and import the same product. Thirdly, trade is often based on products assembled from components that are produced in various countries. Finally, competition usually extends beyond the importing country to include the exporting country 29 and third countries. Hence, trade theories should be considered as broad frameworks that merely describe trade in an ideal situation (Krugman 1983). Though with its limitations, international trade theories do influence the development decisions of international marketing strategy, particularly the economic development and resources endowment measures of each international market. Thus, it could be argued that the understanding of trade flows between countries will impact the effectiveness of international marketing strategy decisions. 2.2.2 Globalisation The origin of globalisation lies with the rapid growth in world trade since the 1950s and the spread of foreign direct investment led by the US, EEC (now EU) and Japan in the 1960s (Waters 2001). However, it has only been in the late 1980s that internationalisation processes have integrated in a more systematic fashion, covering parameters including cross-country investment, production, marketing, trade and more general inter-firm alliances and collaborations (Rodrik 2000). According to Nulty (1990), this rapid expansion in world trade had been supported by a 50% increase in foreign direct investment and even more growth in international stock, bond, and foreign exchange markets. The global economy is now close to 50% integration versus 25% in 1980 and 10% in 1950 (Heenan 1988a). Countries throughout the world are courting multinational corporations as never before in the hope of capturing jobs, technology, capital, and greater economic prosperity (Buckley & Ghauri 2006; Heenan 1988b). 30 The most significant development in the world economy in recent decades has been the increasing globalisation of economic activities. It is emerging as the norm in a growing range of economic activities (Dicken 2003). The world economy is in transition towards a structural shift in international markets and in the production base of advanced countries (Feenstra 1998). As stated by Cohen and Zysman (1988), it will change how production is organised, where it occurs and who plays what role in the process. A number of broad forces have stimulated growth in international competition and widespread globalisation. Early on, Porter (1986) identified these forces as the growing similarity of countries, fluid global capital market, falling tariff barriers, technological restructuring, integrating the role of technology and new global competitors. Today's global economy is genuinely borderless. Information, capital, and innovation flow all over the world, enabled by technology and fuelled by the consumer's desire for access to the best products and services. In a globalised economy, there are implications for marketing. Due to the globalisation influence, international marketers will find more opportunities for global branding and the advantages it delivers, such as greater economies of scale and broader appeal to globetrotting consumers (Dailey & Carley 2003). This globalisation effect is also fuelled through webs of strategic alliances. According to Naisbitt (1994) one of the reasons for the growth of strategic alliances is the need for firms to remain flexible so they are more capable of adjusting to changing market conditions. The author argued in 31 favour of the paradox, "the bigger the world economy, the more powerful its smallest players" (Naisbitt 1994, p. 12). Increasingly, global firms are trying to achieve synergy through coordinated marketing efforts. "From a firm or organisational based perspective globalisation entails the international expansion and integration of key corporate functions such as production, marketing and R&D, as well as the growth in international collaboration and networking with other firms and institutions" (Howells & Wood 1993, p. 3). As the intensity of global competition increases, many firms are forced to re-evaluate their niche in the world market place. For some firms, this revaluation results in strengthening their domestic position against competing foreign products. Other firms respond by aggressively expanding their operations into foreign markets. For many, collaborative agreements with other businesses are an effective alternative to the more traditional approaches. These partnerships, which can extend to strategic alliances, may be viewed as an intermediate position between a focus on domestic markets and full-scale global operation (Doz 1987). Management's assumptions or beliefs, both conscious and unconscious about the nature of the world, also affect the development of an organisation’s international marketing strategy and their response to globalising its operations. The worldview can be described as ethnocentric, polycentric, regiocentric or geocentric (Keegan & Green 2007; Muhlbacher et al. 1999). Management personnel at a firm with a prevailing ethnocentric orientation may consciously make a decision to move in the direction of 32 geocentrism. A person who assumes that his or her country is superior to the rest of the world is said to have an ethnocentric orientation. At some firms, the ethnocentric orientation means that opportunities outside the home country are ignored. Ethnocentric firms that do conduct business outside the home country can be described as international firms. They view foreign operations as being secondary or subordinate to domestic ones (Keegan & Green 2007; Muhlbacher et al. 1999). The term polycentric describes management's belief or assumption that each country in which a firm does business is unique, thus presenting an opposing view to ethnocentrism. This assumption lays the groundwork for each subsidiary to develop its own unique business and marketing strategies in order to succeed; the term multinational firm is often used to describe such a structure (Keegan & Green 2007; Muhlbacher et al. 1999). In a firm with a regiocentric orientation, management views regions as unique and seeks to develop an integrated regional strategy. A firm with a geocentric orientation views the entire world as a potential market and strives to develop integrated world market strategies. A firm whose management has a regiocentric or geocentric orientation is referred to as a global or transnational firm (Keegan & Green 2007; Muhlbacher et al. 1999). Several researchers suggest that many firms are seeking to strengthen their regional competitiveness rather than moving directly to develop global responses to changes in the competitive environment (Morrison et al. 1991; Schlie & Yip 2000). Given the trend towards globalisation, a firm needs to establish whether its approach to international marketing will be local or global, and the 33 extent of standardisation as opposed to differentiation of its offering for each foreign market and between its domestic and its overseas markets. An appreciation of both the micro advantages and macro disadvantages of globalisation needs to be considered in the context of the firm’s international strategic development (Fletcher & Brown 2005). The above discussion on globalisation identifies several important factors to be considered in the development of international marketing strategy. Some of the most important factors to consider are: (1) growth in international competition with the world economy shifting towards international markets, (2) global branding for broader appeal and economies of scale, (3) potential of achieving synergy through coordinated marketing efforts, (4) consideration of management’s assumptions or beliefs when globalising its operation, and (5) establishing whether the organisation’s approach to international marketing will be local or global, and the extent of standardisation as opposed to differentiation of its offering. 2.2.3 Management Decision Making Models Managers have various approaches to decision making depending on the particular situation (Robbins et al. 2006). In general, decisions can be either programmed or non-programmed (Pugh 1997; Simon 1977). Programmed decisions usually involve highly repetitive and routine problems in which the procedures for decision making are well established, applied frequently, easily triggered and require immediate action made by middle to lower groups within an organisation (Lawson & Shen 1998; Simon 1997). In contrast, non-programmed decisions are used when predetermined 34 decision rules are impractical, as in novel or ill-structured situations (Bass 1983). Most managerial decisions are non-programmed and involve significant uncertainty (Bartol et al. 2004; Lawson & Shen 1998; Robbins et al. 2006; Simon 1997). The proportion of non-programmed decisions that managers make increases at each hierarchical level (Bartol et al. 2004). Because these decisions require effective decision making skills and creativity, they provide the biggest challenge to managers. Larrick (1993) points out that preferences for risk or certainty arises not only from the perceived value of outcomes and their probability, but more importantly from the belief that the outcomes will enhance or erode one's self-esteem and efficacy as a decision maker. In general, most people believe that they reason clearly, exercise sound judgment and make decisions rationally and logically. However, many investigators have identified a number of systematic errors and fallacies that people tend to commit when thinking and making decisions (National Advisory Mental Health Council 1996). For example, people are influenced by whether a choice is framed in terms of gains or losses. Similarly, people often take risks because they do not assume that they will have to suffer the consequences. Thus, people's choices are often unduly tilted in the direction of what they want to believe, the confirmatory bias effect. Lastly, in making decisions, people tend to overestimate how many other persons agree with their attitudes and beliefs, a judgmental bias known as the false-consensus bias (Larrick 1993). It is important to be aware of these forces that moderate decision-making so 35 decision-makers can appreciate the value of both the rational, objective forces and the cognitive and affective forces that will shape the decision. Larrick (1993) noted that people usually respond to the emotional consequences of decision making, which were reflected in their feelings of success or failure, enhanced or lowered self-esteem and self-efficacy, elation or disappointment. According to Josephs, Larrick, Steele and Nisbett (1992), when feedback on a decision is poor, people often feel regret, which can tarnish their self-image and lead to self-doubt about the wisdom of the original decision. In this regard, risk preferences are shaped by the motivation to protect one's self-image. Josephs et al. (1992) reported that when faced with risky decisions, persons with low self-esteem were more risk averse when they expected feedback on their decisions, whereas persons with high self-esteem never made regret-minimising choices. It appears, then, that the ability to maintain a good self-image in the face of regret is an important determinant of a person's preference for taking risks. Moreover, Browne (1993) and Harrison (1999) suggested that decision-making involves perceived, rather than objective, measures of risk. Larrick (1993) suggested that primarily cognitive forces determine risk preferences when a given decision poses little or no threat to self-esteem. However, as the potential of a threat to self-esteem increases (for example, when one regrets an earlier, publicly made, decision), risk preferences are determined mainly by the motivation to protect and enhance one's self-image and self-esteem. 36 Thus multiple internal human forces are manipulated by external factors. All of this will then determine the capacity of a decision maker to undergo the process and arrive at an appropriate solution. When considering the impact that such societal and individual forces will have on decisionmaking it becomes clear that the social system will fundamentally impact the quality of the decision-making. Hence, the interdisciplinary aspects of decision-making are best illustrated within the framework of proposed models. Such models show graphically how much emphasis applicable disciplines receive in decisionmaking. Moreover, models represent a particular segment of the real world at a given time and place under varying conditions. Such a model should enable the decision maker to predict real-world phenomena with valuable consistency and accuracy. Browne (1993) and Harrison (1993) point out that there are four decision models. These are the rationality, bounded-rationality, political models and process models, as shown in the Table 2.1, and briefly discussed in this section. Table 2.: Interdisciplinary Models of Decision-making Model Rational (classical) Criterion Maximised outcome Key Ingredients Objectives: specific states of nature; subjective probabilities; quantified utilities; exhaustive alternatives; computational decision-making strategy; short-term horizon; highly structured process 37 Key Assumptions Fixed objectives unlimited information, no cognitive limitations; no time and cost constraints; quantifiable and controlled variables; closed system; quantitatively limited outcomes Model Criterion Key Ingredients Key Assumptions Organisational (neoclassical) Satisficing outcome Objectives: general states of nature limited subjective probabilities; partially quantified utilities; nonexhaustive alternatives; sensitive environment; judgmental decision-making strategy; short-term horizon; moderately structured process Attainable objectives: limited information; cognitive limitations; time and cost constraints; partially quantifiable and intransitive alternatives; open system; qualitatively and moderately quantitatively limited Political (adaptive) Acceptable outcome Objectives: general states of nature; no probabilities; unquantifiable utilities; nonexhaustive alternatives; dominant environment; compromise or bargaining decision-making strategy; restricted number of outcomes; short-term horizon; incremental steps; loosely structured process Limited objective: unlimited information; no cognitive limitations; no time and cost constraints; non-quantifiable and generally transitive alternative; open system; environmentally-limited outcomes; no "right" decision Process (managerial) Objectives oriented outcome Objectives: general states of nature; generally subjective probabilities; objectivesoriented utilities; exhaustive alternatives; sensitive to environment constraints; judgemental decision-making strategy with selective use of computation and compromise; long-term horizon; limited number of outcomes; highly structured process Highly dynamic objective: limited information; cognitive limitations; time and cost constraints generally nonquantifiable and intransitive alternatives; open system; sequential decision-making functions; objective-oriented outcomes Source: Adapted from Harrison (1993) 2.2.3.1 The Rational Model The Rational Model is the classical approach in the field of decision theory. It is based on the assumptions that decision makers are entirely rational and seek the best or most effective alternatives that consistently maximise value within the specified constraints of a given problem (Browne 1993; Langley 38 1989; Simon 1986). Their aim is making optimal decisions on the basis of a careful evaluation of alternative course of actions. This model provides the foundation for the quantitative disciplines of economics, mathematics and statistics (Bartol et al. 2004). Indeed, the Rational Model is the main reason many people regard decision making as essentially quantitative (Harrison 1993). The Rational Model explicitly presumes that if a given variable cannot be assigned a numeric value, it should be disregarded or assumed away as a constant or given value. It is a model that operates within a closed environment with a single fixed objective and precise number of variables. It views the decision-making process as a linear, sequential series of activities (Harrison & Harrison 1999; Minkes 1987) as depicted in Figure 2.2. Figure 2.: The Rational Decision-making Model Define the Problem Identify the Decision Criteria Allocate weights to the Criteria Develop the Alternatives Evaluate the Alternatives Select the best Alternative Source: Adapted from Harrison and Harrison (1999) 39 It involves diagnosing and defining the problem, identifying the decision criteria by gathering and analysing the facts relevant to the problem, allocating weights to the previously identified criteria, developing and evaluating alternative solutions and selecting the best alternative (Harrison & Harrison 1999). In general, individuals and organisations aspire to make as many decisions as possible on the basis of rational considerations. However, obstacles such as constraints on resources, the nature of the organisations, and limited information that can be assembled and processed by the decisionmaking group within a given time can hinder it from doing so. The Rational Model is based on the assumption that all the significant variables in a given decision-making situation can be quantified to some degree. It further assumes that decision makers have complete information about the opportunity or problems, have complete information about all alternatives and the consequences of selecting one alternative over another, and make a decision solely on the basis of expectations about future outcomes, rather than on power or political considerations (Harrison & Harrison 1999). Thus, the Rational Model is of limited use in most real-world managerial decisions involving high level of uncertainty. This model may have limited applicability in making operational decisions characterised by high levels of certainty in their outcomes or in conducting academic instruction to illustrate hypothetical relationships among variables. 40 selective decision-making 2.2.3.2 The Bounded Rationality Model This model, also referred to as the Organisational Model, has been put forth as a more accurate description of how decisions are actually made in many organisations (Cyert & March 1963; March & Simon 1993; Simon 1955; 1997). A fundamental assumption of this model is that decision makers behave rationally within the constraints of their cognitive capabilities to attend to, and define, the problem and gain information about alternatives. In other words, decision makers aspire to make optimal choices but are limited by the many boundaries to rationality, including the following: (1) Decision makers lack the cognitive resources to maximise, (2) Do not know the relevant probabilities of outcomes, (3) Rarely evaluate all outcomes with sufficient precision, and (4) Decisions may be based on criteria other than the rational and logical evaluation of information, such as consideration of member's preferences and coalitions in the organisation (Simon 1977; 1997). As a consequence of the cognitive constraints of not being able to gather and process all the possible information, decision makers satisfice rather than optimise by selecting the alternative that appears good enough to solve the problem (Simon 1977; 1997). The Bounded Rationality Model tends to be eclectic in that it combines the behavioural disciplines with quantitative analysis to arrive at an outcome that fits the constraints caused by the external environment (Harrison 1993). This model is similar to the Rational Model, and like the Rational Model, this model is best suited for decisions made using relatively stable, routine organisational processes with a high level of certainly on the outcome, so 41 decision making within this model is normally made at lower levels in the organisation (Harrison 1993). According to Simon (1955; 1977; 1997), there are five significant deviations from the Rational Model which reflect the behavioural aspects of managerial decision making in organisations. (1) Factored decisions: managerial decisions are often so complex that only a limited number of their aspects can be attended to at a time. Thus, managerial decision makers must divide decisions into a number of roughly interdependent parts and deal with the parts one by one within the various units of the organisation. (2) Satisficing outcome: Maximising outcomes, which is characteristic of the rational model, is replaced by the satisficing of outcomes in the organisational model. (3) Search: Organisations generate alternatives by relatively stable, sequential search procedures. (4) Uncertainty avoidance: Uncertainty tends to be avoided by making choices, which emphasise short-run feedback to provide for timely changes in emerging outcomes which appear to diverge from the objective at hand. (5) Repertoires: Organisations tend to have second and third alternatives, which may be implemented if feedback indicates that a presumed satisfying choice is not yielding a desirable outcome (Simon 1955; 1977; 1997). As shown in Table 2.1 on page 37, this Organisational Model represents a significant departure from the classical model. Fixed objectives 42 are replaced by attainable objectives, which may be scaled downward if the search does not reveal adequate alternatives. The Organisational Model acknowledges the constraints of limited information, cognitive limitations and time and cost limitations. As such, the Organisational Model introduces the disciplines of philosophy, psychology and sociology into the decision-making situation. This model is open to environmental influences and accepts outcomes on their qualitative as well as their quantitative merits (Simon 1977; 1997). 2.2.3.3 The Political Model The Political Model suggests that decisions result from bargaining by individuals or coalitions, rather than from the operation of routine organisational information gathering and processing (Harrison 1993). Cyert and March (1963) argued that organisations should be understood as consisting of shifting coalitions that form and reform around issues of concern to them and their view recognises the role of conflict and conflict resolution in the decision-making process. Accordingly, decision-making is a matter of seeking a solution that is acceptable to all parties and following a strategy of incrementalism in search of what is possible, rather than what is optimal or satisficing (Harrison 1993). This model is almost totally behavioural in its orientation (Lawson & Shen 1998). The primary criterion for decision-making in the Political Model is an outcome that is acceptable to many external constituencies. Consequently, the Political Model employs a bargaining or compromise decision-making strategy. 43 This incremental approach to decision-making limits the definition of the problem, the information search processes, the number of alternatives and the number of participants to only those who have a stake in the outcome and power either to block or implement the decision. Harrison (1999) and Browne (1993) noted that political decision-making usually includes: (1) Considering only alternatives that differ slightly, marginally, or incrementally from existing policies or practices, (2) Considering a small number of alternatives and only those with limited consequences, (3) Continually massaging or redefining the problem and alternative to make the decision acceptable to all parties, and (4) Focusing on short term problems. The Political Model of decision-making is characteristic of most organisations in the public sector and seems unlike to be used widely in the private sector (Harrison 1993). 2.2.3.4 The Process Model In the Process Model, decision-making has a strong managerial emphasis and its objectives are focused on achieving outcomes. This model is suitable when decisions are made in a climate of uncertainty on the outcome. Such decisions include those made at mid and senior levels of management both in the private and the public sectors where the consequences are of a high level of significance to the organisation (Harrison 1993). Moreover, the Process Model is ideal for these kinds of decisions because it is forward looking in that it has a planning emphasis not apparent 44 in the other models of decision-making (Elbing 1978). Harrison (1993) also points out that the Process Model is oriented towards innovation and organisational change with a particular emphasis on long-term results. It relies principally on the judgement of the decision maker, but not on the exclusion of computation or compromise to fit special decision-making situations. It enhances the role of all types of decision-making (Harrison 1993). Research has shown that the Process Model is a primary contributor to decision success (Harrison 1993). The net result of its initial adoption or its selective emphasis should be decisions that are more likely to attain managerial objectives and fulfil organisational purposes. Harrison and Harrison (1999) and Drucker et al. (2001) noted that the components of the decision-making process model include the following functions: (1) Setting managerial objectives (2) Searching for alternatives (3) Comparing and evaluating alternatives (4) Choosing the decision (5) Implementing the decision (6) Following up and controlling the decision In summary, each of the models is designed to take the personal and social impacts of decision-making and process them into stages such that each can be independently analysed. The models however are based on general societal characteristics rather than specific situations. Consequently, they cannot be readily applied where the personal and social forces are inconsistent with the models’ assumptions. 45 However, according to Courtney (2001), the decision making process is moving towards a new paradigm in today’s environment where there is an overwhelming amount of data to examine with emphasis towards considering many other viewpoints than just the technical perspective. Rather than simply analysing the technical perspective, this new process advocates developing different perspectives as insights are gained and updated with the creation of tacit knowledge and learning taking place. Thus, in light of the development of international marketing strategy, one factor that is anticipated to play an influencing role in management decisions is the overall feel about certain international marketing strategies; whether the market data evaluated are consistent with management's overall feel or not, will play a decisive role in its development process. Therefore, it is argued here that the understanding of management decision making process and theories will have impact on the effectiveness of international marketing strategy decisions. 2.2.4 Strategic Management Strategy is defined in the Oxford English Dictionary (1993, p. 3085) as “the art or skill of careful planning towards an advantage or a desired end, and a plan for successful action based on the rationality and interdependence of the moves of opposing or competing participants”. In the business context, it can be defined as “those decisions which have high medium-term to long-term impact on the activities of the organisation, including the implementation of those decisions, to create value for customers and key stakeholders and to outperform competitors” (Hubbard 2004, p. 1). 46 Strategy relates to decision making and its implementation. It is about long term impacts of important decisions for the organisation, and the integration and focus of business functions. Strategy is also related to outperforming competitors and creating value for customers and key stakeholders (Hubbard 2004). Strategy is a deliberate, structured process by which a business searches and analyses its environment and resources in order to (1) select opportunities defined in terms of markets to be served and products to serve them and (2) make discrete decisions to invest resources in order to achieve identified objectives (Bower 1970; Mintzberg et al. 2002). The early concept of strategy according to Henry Mintzberg has many dimensions and approaches. These include Strategy as a Plan, Strategy as a Ploy, Strategy as a Pattern, Strategy as a Position, and Strategy as a Perspective (Mintzberg 1987). Strategy is a plan: a consciously intended course of purposeful action, a set of guidelines to deal with a situation. As a plan, a strategy can be a ploy, as being a specific manoeuvre intended to outwit an opponent or competitor. Strategy as a pattern in the sense of consistency in actions, activities and behaviour, whether or not intended. Strategy as a position means the way organisations position themselves to the competition and locating the organisation in what management theorists term as an environment. By this definition, strategy becomes the mediating force or match, according to Hofer and Schendel (1978), between firm and environment; that is, between the internal and external context. Strategy as a perspective has its content consisting not just of a chosen position, but of an ingrained way of perceiving the world. Many management scholars have used 47 terms such as the theory of the business and its driving force (Drucker 2007; Tregoe & Zimmerman 1983) to explain this phenomenon. Much of the current literature in international marketing and strategic marketing does in general portray international marketing strategy as a plan, a pattern, a ploy, a position, and as a perspective (Bennett & Blythe 2002; Bradley 2005; Doole & Lowe 2008; Fifield & Lewis 1998; Jeannet & Hennessey 2004). This literature directs marketers to consider market and industry factors in the development process, as well as the matching aspect between the firm’s internal factors and its external environment. Michael Porter stated that “the essence of strategy is choosing to perform activities differently than rivals do” (Porter 1996, p. 64) and “strategy is the creation of a unique and valuable position involving a different set of activities [from competitors] … creating a fit among a company’s activities” (Porter 1996, p. 68). This supports the view of defining strategy as a ploy, a specific manoeuvre designed to outwit competitors and strategy as a position which is consistent with Porter’s view of strategy in terms of his generic strategies which can be applied to broad or narrow markets. Porter's (1985) framework of generic strategies constitute strategies that are widely applicable across industries regardless of technological base, nature of competition, industry life cycle, number of competitors and geographical spread. Porter believed there are two “basic types of competitive advantage a firm can possess: low cost or differentiation” (1985, p. 11). Combining these with a firm's scope of activities provides three general competitive strategies for above average performance in an industry: cost leadership, differentiation, and focus. 48 In order to maintain sustainable competitive advantage necessary to achieve growth, Porter (1990b) proposed that an organisation should adopt any one of the three generic strategies. However, each poses particular challenges for organisations in international markets: (1) Cost leadership requires the business to establish a lower cost base than its local or international competitors. The sources of cost advantage may include proprietary technology, economies of scale, access to raw materials and process design. This strategy utilises its low-cost advantage to attract customers by offering lower prices while maintaining industry comparable returns. Particularly for SMEs and due to their limited financial resources, they are vulnerable to either local firms or larger multi-nationals temporarily cutting prices to force the firm out of the market as they tend to spend little on marketing activity. Alternatively, instability in the economic climate or fluctuations in currency exchange rates can result in newer, lower priced competitors emerging. (2) Differentiation is achieved through emphasising particular benefits in the product, service, or marketing mix, which customers think are important and a significant improvement over competitive offers. Organisations that achieve and sustain such a difference will be an above-average performer in its industry if its price premium exceeds the extra cost incurred in being unique. Whilst most organisations are flexible, adaptable and responsive to customer needs, the cost of maintaining high levels of differentiation over competitors in a number 49 of international markets can be demanding of management time and financial resources, especially for SMEs. (3) Focus is when the firm concentrates on one or more narrow segments in the industry and thus builds up specialist knowledge of each segment. Typically, this strategy necessitates high levels of customer and technical service support which can be resource intensive. Unless the organisation has created a highly specialised niche, it may be difficult to defend against local and international competition (Porter 1990a). Despite the fundamental importance of Porter’s generic strategies, surprisingly there is little research evidence about their success. Studies during the 1990s tended to conclude that they are contingent upon the operating environment (Chan & Wong 1999) and that some researchers believe that a combination of strategies is possible (Kim & Mauborgne 2008; Miller & Dess 1993; Ridderstrale & Nordstrom 2008). They suggest that the original either/or choice is just one of the choices possible. “A strategy of a corporation forms a comprehensive master plan stating how the corporation will achieve its mission and objectives. It maximises competitive advantage and minimises competitive disadvantage” (Wheelan & Hunger 2007, p. 16). The essence of creating competitive advantage and outperforming competitors, which is the aim of strategy, is to create superior value for the customers with activities carried out by the organisation using its superior resources and capabilities. Resources can be a source of competitive advantage by themselves, but it is generally of little use without capabilities. Both resources and 50 capabilities are required to generate strategic capabilities for the organisation in order to create competitive advantage and provide superior value for the customers as shown in Figure 2.3. Figure 2.: Resources, Capabilities and the Creation of Value Resources Strategic Capabilities Competitive Advantage Customer Value Capabilities Source: Adapted from Hubbard (2004) Furthermore, the resource-based view of the theoretical approach to strategy argues that all sustainable competitive advantage is built on the unique resources that the organisation has within it. This resource-based view was popularised by Prahalad and Hamel (1990) who developed a concept called the core competence of the organisation. For an organisation to create a sustainable competitive advantage from its capabilities, these resources need to be valuable, rare, imperfectly imitable and difficult to substitute. It is therefore essential in undertaking analysis to identify the organisation’s core competencies and the long-term market needs it serves, together with the unique capabilities required to deliver value profitably to that market. In the development of international marketing strategy, this would 51 mean assessing an organisation's international capabilities to match the needs of the target market (Muhlbacher et al. 1999). The issue of competitive advantage as the major driving force in marketing strategy decision making has been well recognised by many other researchers (Bharadwaj et al. 1993; Faulkner 2002; Jaworski & Kohli 1993; Ling-Yee & Ogunmokun 2001; Morgan & Hunt 1999; Slater & Narver 1994; Woodruff 1997). Firms internationalise to overcome competition and to exploit their competitive advantages in new markets. Hence, when developing international marketing strategy, the organisation must consider the firm's capabilities with market opportunities. The arena of competition must be chosen with the firm's resources focused on that arena in pursuit of the firm's objectives (Prahalad & Hamel 1990). The corporate mission determines the parameters of the specific objectives to be defined by top management. Wheelan and Hunger (2007) identified some of the areas in which an organisation might establish its goals and objectives, which include profitability, market share and growth. These objectives are listed as the results of planned activities. All these objectives are also relevant in the international marketing strategy development process. The concept of a corporate mission implies that throughout the organisation's many activities, there should be a unifying theme and that those firms with such a common thread are better able to direct and administer their activities (Dess 1987). In developing new products, entering new markets or acquiring new firms, such a corporation looks for strategic fit. That is, the likelihood that new activities will mesh with the present ones in such a way that the firm's overall effectiveness and efficiency will be 52 increased. This implies that when developing international marketing strategy, not only should the international marketing strategy have synergy with the organisation's existing strategic capabilities, but also synergy with its existing and targeted markets (Doole & Lowe 2008). Strategic choices have wide-ranging ripple effects through the organisation. They determine the key success factors, dictate the programs and projects to initiate and continue, define the skills and resources to mobilise or acquire, and shape expectations for profit and growth performance. In brief, they give meaning and direction to the myriad activities of the business (Day 2007). Once the choice is made, the organisation must strive to compete, survive, and prosper within the forces at work in the chosen marketplace and within the general profit potential of that market (Hubbard 2004). At the same time, it must accept that most of its learning, and therefore the character and value of its resource base, will be shaped by the chosen environment. Both environment and organisation will evolve and adapt interdependently. It has been generally accepted in the literature that strategy creates fit between a firm and its environment (Varadarajan & Clark 1994). Thus, international marketers when developing their international marketing strategy should evaluate strategic fit in making their decisions. Strategic fit in terms of achieving objectives regarding growth, profits and market share as well as fit between its own practices and those of the target markets, as business practices of international markets vary widely. The above discussion on the current relevant literature in strategic management and marketing strategy identifies important factors to be 53 considered in the development of international marketing strategy. Some of the most important dimensions to consider are: (1) consideration of competition and the organisation’s competitive advantages, (2) potential of achieving competitive advantage through relationship building and alliances, (3) assessment of the organisation’s own competencies and finding a fit with the target markets, (4) assessment of fit between the organisation’s objectives regarding market share, growth and profit, and (5) finding synergy with the organisation’s strategic capabilities as well as with its existing and targeted markets. 2.2.4.1 Strategy Development Process An organisation’s strategy normally starts with a clear intended plan, after analysing the various environmental, industry and organisational factors, discussing them with other managers, and expressing them in a formal plan (Hubbard 2004). This is the intended strategy which is an expression of the desired strategic direction deliberately formulated and planned by managers (Mintzberg et al. 2008). This intended strategy development process can be achieved with strategic planning, as often, strategy development is equated with formalised strategic planning systems (Bradford & Duncan 1999; Bryson 2004; Haines 2000). However, the practice of top-down strategic planning seems to be declining in recent years with the shift to line managers taking responsibility for their strategy development (McLarney 2003). The development process of intended strategy can also be accomplished by holding strategic workshops 54 with project groups, engaging outside strategy consultants and/or imposed externally by powerful external stakeholders (Johnson et al. 2005). On the other hand, the development process of emergent strategy as the realised strategy occurs as a result of daily routines, activities and processes within the organisation that give rise to decisions that become the long-term direction of that organisation (Mintzberg & Waters 1985). The organisational processes that might account for the development of emergent strategy are logical incrementalism, resources allocation routines, cultural processes and political processes (Johnson et al. 2005). Logical incrementalism according to Quinn (1980) involves “learning from partial commitments rather than through global formulations of total strategies” (Quinn 1980, p. 58). That is, emergent strategy is developed by experimentation which relies on the social processes within the organisation to sense environmental changes and try out new ideas. Resources allocation routines on the development process of emergent strategy on the other hand, identify the process in which strategy emerges in organisations through formalised routines and systems of the organisation. That is, strategy develops as the outcome of resource allocation routines in organisations, sometimes known as the Bower-Burgelman explanation (Bower 1986; Burgelman 1983a). This development process was also found to be similar in other later studies in this area (Noda & Bower 1996). Organisational culture and politics also influence the strategy development process. The culture of an organisation has a strong impact on the emergent and incremental development of strategy through the way things were done around here. This in effect is organisational culture driving the 55 strategy and hence influencing the strategy development process (Mintzberg 1994). This was confirmed by a study by Menon et al. (1999) which found that innovative culture is the fundamental antecedent of effective marketing strategy making and that strategy creativity directly affects market performance of an organisation. This implies that organisational culture and managerial creativity are important attributes in the development of strategy. Power politics in an organisation can also have a serious effect on the strategy development process through the outcome of the processes of bargaining and negotiation among powerful internal and external interest groups or stakeholders (Buchanan & Boddy 1992). Within all these processes, individuals do seem to play an important part in strategy development. Strategic leadership from the CEO, business founder, and top management influence the development of strategy through their vision. Such visionary capacity can be explained in terms of their intuition. Research indicates that this capacity of managers to use their intuition in decision making also plays an important role in strategy development (Clarke & Mackaness 2001). As can be seen, different explanatory theories as to the nature of the strategy development process have been advanced. Rather than assume a unitary explanation of the strategy development process, it is recognised that the process is likely to be multifaceted (Eisenhardt & Zbaracki 1992). Much literature in the field emphasises a deliberate process of managerial choice (Bailey & Johnson 1995; Bailey et al. 2000; Hart & Banbury 1994). In the Bailey and Johnson (1995) research on the strategy development process, 56 the three broad approaches to strategy development: (1) strategic choice, (2) social processes, and (3) environmental factors are split into six distinct dimensions. In their studies, these are labelled as command, planning, incremental, political, cultural and enforced choice. Table 2.2 summarises the characteristics of these six dimensions, citing studies examining each of the dimensions which are related to other models of strategy development, most notably to Hart and Banbury’s (1994) five dimensions of strategy development, labelled as command, rational, transactive, generative and symbolic, which correspond closely to Bailey and Johnson’s (1995) command, planning, incremental, political and cultural dimensions. Table 2.: Characteristics of Six Dimensions of Strategy Development Command Description Key References A particular individual is seen to have a high degree of control over the strategy followed; for example the chief executive or a similar figure with institutionalised authority. Less commonly, such influence may relate to the power of a small group of individuals at the top of the organisation. Control and influence may be exercised in different ways, for example through personality, the rigid enactment of rules or through expertise. Alternatively, strategic aspirations and strategy may emerge from a vision associated with the powerful individual(s), which represents the desired future state of the organisation. (Bourgeois & Brodwin 1984) 57 (Bennis & Nanus 1985) (Shrivastava & Grant 1985) (Westley & Mintzberg 1989) (Kotter 1990) Description Planning Incremental Political Cultural An intentional process involving a logical, sequential, analytic and deliberate set of procedures. The organisation and its environment are systematically analysed. Strategic options are generated and systematically evaluated. Based on this assessment, the option is chosen that is judged to maximize the value of outcomes in relation to organisational goals. The selected option is subsequently detailed in the form of precise implementation plans, and systems for monitoring and controlling the strategy are determined. There is an assumption here that strategy is developed by top executives and implemented by those below. Strategic choice takes place through 'successive limited comparisons'. Strategic goals and objectives of the organisation are not likely to be precise but general in nature. The uncertainty of the environment is accepted and as such managers are not able to know how it will change: rather they attempt to be sensitive to it through constant scanning and evaluation. Commitment to a strategic option may be tentative and subject to review in the early stages of development. Organisations are political arenas in which decision-making and strategy development is a political matter. Differences amongst stakeholders are resolved through bargaining, negotiation and compromise. Coalitions may form to pursue shared objectives and to sponsor different strategic options. The level of influence these stakeholders are able to exercise is conditional upon the organisation's dependency upon such groups for resources. Further, information is not politically neutral, but rather is a source of power for those who control it. Strategy is influenced by taken-for-granted frames of reference shared amongst organisational members. These frames of reference help to simplify the complexity of situations, provide a ready-made interpretation of new situations, enable decisions to be made in a way which makes contextual sense and provide a guide to appropriate behaviour. Their usefulness increases as situations become more ambiguous and the efficiency of formal decision-making processes decreases. These frames of reference are underpinned by routines, rituals, stories and other symbolic artefacts which represent and reinforce the organisational culture. These cultural artefacts embed frames of reference in organisational activities and provide a repertoire for action; but are in turn likely to be resistant to change. 58 Key References (Ansoff 1965) (Steiner 1969) (Mintzberg 1978) (Argenti 1980) (Rowe et al. 1993) (Lindblom 1959) (Mintzberg et al. 1976) (Quinn 1980) (Quinn 1982) (Johnson 1988) (Cyert & March 1963) (Pettigrew 1973) (Hinings et al. 1974) (Pfeffer & Salancik 1978) (Wilson 1982) (Feldman 1986) (Hickson et al. 1986) (Weick 1979) (Deal & Kennedy 1982) (Schon 1995) (Gioia & Poole 1984) (Trice & Beyer 1985) (Johnson 1987) (Spender 1989) Description Enforced Choice Factors in the environment encourage the adoption of organisational structures and activities which best fit that environment. These external constraints may take the form of regulative coercion, competitive or economic pressures or normative pressures as to what constitutes legitimate organisational action. These pressures limit the role organisational member play in the choice of strategy. So the strategies an organisation can follow tend to be common to organisations within their industrial sector or organisational field; with changes coming about through variations in organisations' processes and systems which may occur unintentionally or through imperfect imitation of successful structures, systems or processes. Key References (Aldrich 1979) (DiMaggio & Powell 1983) (Hannan & Freeman 1989) (Deephouse 1996) Source: Adapted from Bailey, Johnson & Daniels (2000) From the above discussion of the various strategy development processes and dimensions, several important general points are raised. Firstly, there seems to be no right way in which strategies are developed. Strategies developed in an uncertain and fast changing environment are not likely to be the same when developed in an environment of certainty and little change. Secondly, the processes of strategy development differ over time and in difference contexts. The strategy development processes in an organisation going through rapid changes are not likely to be the same when the organisation is in a steady state. Thirdly, the perceptions of how strategies develop will be seen differently by different people. Senior executives and middle managers of private businesses, small business entrepreneurs and managers of public sectors or government and its agencies each see the process of strategy development differently (Bailey & Johnson 1995). 59 Finally, there are likely to be multiple developmental processes at work. In fact, there is evidence that organisations that employ multiple processes of strategy development seem to perform better than those that take a singular approach (Hart & Banbury 1994). 2.2.5 Marketing Strategy Porter’s (1985) generic strategy of low cost, differentiation, and focus remain the dominant influencing strategy decision models in a range of frameworks guiding strategy decision (Aaker 2007; Day 1999). Furthermore, Sudharshan (1995) has postulated that marketing strategy is a function of an organisation’s marketing relationships with their customers and channel members. According to Jarratt and Fayed (2001, p. 70), “research has identified a change in emphasis for marketing, with the marketer of the future being involved in the management of relationships that underpin customer value creation, and being directly involved in the strategic processes that create key capabilities underpinning competitive advantage”. Hence, some researchers are proposing customer relationships as the key resources in determining the organisation’s competitive position (Pitt & Morris 1995; Webster 1992). Other marketing scholars (Bharadwaj et al. 1993; Day & Wensley 1988; Jaworski & Kohli 1993; 1996; Kohli & Jaworski 1990; Narver & Slater 1990; Slater & Narver 1994) have directed marketing strategy decision makers to adopt a competitive advantage, organisational market-orientation foundation to developing marketing strategy, supporting marketing strategy decisions based on information management and dissemination, organisational skills and 60 resources, and current competitive comparisons. Some literature (Markides & Williamson 1994; Prahalad & Hamel 1990; Stalk et al. 1992) also suggests that strategy be re-thought in terms of the key capabilities that can be accessed through strategic alliances. Strategic marketing is marketing decisions made within a framework of corporate inputs, portfolio and finance consideration, and strategic intelligence synthesis. Marketing strategies are functional strategies developed at the business unit level by marketing personnel within the marketing department (Jain 2004). The role of middle management marketers’ increasing influence on strategic direction resulting in positive impact on organisational performance was confirmed by Schilit (1987). These roles include championing initiatives (Hutt et al. 1988), synthesising information (Nonaka 1988), facilitating adaptability (Burgelman 1983b), and implementing deliberate strategy (Nutt 1987). The concept of strategic marketing revolves around the 3Cs of Corporation, Customer and Competition within an external environment of social, technological, political / legal and economic changes as depicted in Figure 2.4 on the next page. 61 Figure 2.: Key Elements of Marketing Strategy Source: Adapted from Jain (2004) Based on the interplay of the three strategic components of corporation, customer and competitor, the formulation of marketing strategy requires three decisions on where to compete; how to compete; and when to compete. Strategic marketing focuses on choosing the right products for the right growth markets at the right time. Hence, marketing strategy is the creation of a unique and valuable position involving a chosen set of activities that are different from its rivals to achieve its designated intentions (Jain 2004). Thus, marketing strategies focus on ways in which the business can differentiate itself effectively 62 from its competitors, capitalising on its distinctive strengths to deliver better value to its customers (Jain 2004). Marketing strategy places emphasis on long-term orientation with implications that require greater monitoring of the environment and strategic intelligence inputs. Other inputs required for making strategic marketing decisions can come from various stakeholders in the organisation, corporate culture and the organisational resources. These corporate inputs will assist in formulating the marketing strategies for a sustainable competitive advantage for the organisation (Doole & Lowe 2005). Strategic marketing places emphasis on the varying roles of the different products / markets. It premises that different products within different product life cycles serve different purposes and expectations for the business and therefore require different marketing strategies (Harrell & Taylor 1981). With the application of the product portfolio approach advanced by Boston Consulting Group’s portfolio matrix, this is now commonly used to formulate marketing strategies for different products in different markets (Haspeslagh 1982). Because marketing strategy interfaces with, and affects the perspectives of an entire organisation, strategic marketing decision making is closely related to other functional units, in particular the finance function of the organisation (Ruekert & Walker 1987). In recent years, frameworks such as the value-based planning approach have been developed to relate marketing to finance in making strategic decisions (Almquist & Wyner 2001; Kotler & Keller 2006). In the development process of strategy, the first step is to consider the situation analysis and determine issues and opportunities to be addressed. After this, the business needs to establish their strategic options; that is 63 growth, maintain, harvest or divest (Hubbard 2004). When the business intends to pursue growth as an option, there are several different approaches to strategy development and the theories to be addressed include: Strategies Based on Competitive Advantage Porter (1985) argued that strategy encompasses two generic options of how to compete: differentiation or cost leadership. Within this framework, a business must decide where to compete; that is total market or focus. In addition, Porter believed these strategies are mutually exclusive - you can only pursue one or the other. In today's dynamic environment, this may not be true as some scholars believe that a combination of strategies is possible (Chan & Wong 1999; Miller & Dess 1993). Strategies Based on Products and Markets One way of developing organisational strategies is to focus on the directions the organisation can take in order to grow. Table 2.3 representing the productmarket matrix presents the available choices of four strategies an organisation can take in order to grow. It indicates that an organisation can grow by better managing what it is presently doing or by finding new things to do. Table 2.: Growth Strategies - Products and Markets Products Markets Present Customers New Customers Present Products New Products Market Penetration Product Development Market Development Diversification Source: Adapted from Hubbard (2004) 64 Market penetration focuses primarily on increasing sales of present products to present customers. That is, getting existing customers to buy more products or finding new uses. Market development pursues growth through seeking new customers for its present products. Product development through new products / improvements or product extensions developed would be directed primarily to present segments, and diversification can lead the organisation to an entirely new and even unrelated business. It involves seeking new products (often through acquisition) for customers currently not being served by the firm (Hubbard 2004; Jarratt 2006). Strategies Based on Value As competition increases, the concept of customer value has become significant for marketers (Peter & Donnelly 2003). It is an extension of the marketing concept by going beyond satisfying customer needs. This focuses not only on customer needs, but on how to create value for customers (Mittal 2001; Rust et al. 2000). It is unlikely that a business can be all things to all people. Thus, to succeed, many organisations are opting to build long term relationships with their customers by offering a unique value that only they can offer (Hubbard 2004). This provides a competitive advantage that is very difficult for competitors to copy. It appears that many organisations have succeeded by choosing to deliver superior customer value using one of three value strategies: (1) Best price (termed operational excellence) (2) Best product (termed product leadership) 65 (3) Best service (termed customer intimacy) (Jain 2004) To summarise, strategic marketing processes are multi-level processes where the outcomes of decisions are shaped by the interest and commitments of individuals and groups, the organisational momentum, important changes in the environment, and the manipulation of the structural context surrounding decisions rather than a linear progression from strategy formulation to strategy implementation. These multi-level processes will impact the effectiveness of international marketing strategy decisions through the 3Cs of Corporation, Customer and Competition within an external environment of social, technological, political / legal and economic changes. 2.2.6 International Marketing Marketing, the parent discipline of international marketing is defined by Kotler (1999, p. 13) as: “the process of planning and executing the conception, pricing, promotion and distribution of goods, services, and ideas to create exchanges with target groups that satisfy customer and organisational objectives”. With the flourishing of relationship marketing in the 1900s, this traditional approach to marketing has, however, been increasingly questioned in recent years. The new relationship approach, whilst recognising the key elements mentioned above, reflects the need to create an integrated crossfunctional focus of marketing - one which emphasises keeping, as well as winning customers (Payne 1995). More recently the focus of marketing is shifting to embrace both customer acquisition and customer retention, ensuring that appropriate 66 amounts of time, money and managerial resources are directed at both of these key tasks. Marketing involves competing through competencies and capabilities, and building value to customers through managing relationships that deliver value (Golfetto & Gibbert 2006; Payne & Holt 2001). As discussed in Section 2.2.5, recent literature suggests an increasing need for market-led or market oriented marketing strategies to cope with the changing marketing environment, to provide competitive advantage, and create value for customers. Thus, in taking a leading role in the development and the implementation of strategy, the role of marketing can be re-defined in a way as shown in Figure 2.5. Figure 2.: The Role of Marketing in the Organisation Identify and communicate customer wants and needs throughout the organisation Determine the competitive positioning to match the needs of the customers with company capabilities Marshal all relevant organisational resources to deliver customer satisfaction Source: Adapted from Hooley, Saunders, & Piercy (2004) The first essential task of marketing is to identify the requirements of customers and to communicate them effectively throughout the organisation. This may involve conducting or commissioning relevant customer research to 67 uncover first, who the customers are, and second, what will give them satisfaction (Hooley et al. 2004). Recognising that markets are heterogeneous and typically made up of various market segments each having different requirements, leads to the need to decide clearly which target market(s) the organisation will seek to serve (Hooley et al. 2004). That decision is based on two sets of factors: first, how attractive the alternative potential targets are; and second, how well the firm can serve each potential target market relative to the competition (Hooley et al. 2004). The third important task of marketing is to marshal all the relevant organisational resources to plan and execute the delivery of customer satisfaction. This may involve ensuring that all members of the organisation are co-ordinated in their efforts to manage the relationship and satisfy the customers (Hooley et al. 2004). Terpstra and Sarathy (2000, p. 4) defined international marketing as “finding and satisfying global customer needs better than the competition, both domestic and international, and of coordinating marketing activities within the constraints of the global environment”. This definition is still considered in the traditional context and reflects on how international marketing concepts are falling behind the developments in the mother discipline of marketing. Nevertheless, this definition of international marketing very much retains the basic marketing principle satisfaction (Terpstra & Sarathy 2000). The fact that transactions take place across national borders highlights the difference between domestic and international marketing. The international marketer is subject to a new set of macro environmental factors, different 68 constraints on business conduct and frequent conflicts resulting from different laws, regulations, cultures and societies. The basic principles of marketing still apply, but their applications, complexity, and intensity vary substantially (Terpstra & Sarathy 2000). Conversely, most scholars on international marketing (Czinkota & Ronkanien 2006; Fletcher & Brown 2005; Jain 1996; Jeannet & Hennessey 2004; Johansson 2005; Keegan 2001; Keegan & Green 1997; Terpstra & Sarathy 2000) have agreed that the basic nature of marketing does not change from domestic to international marketing, but marketing outside national boundaries does pose special problems as it operates simultaneously in more than one kind of environment. In relation to the development of international marketing strategy, there are four major approaches in which businesses can enter international markets: (1) direct exporting, (2) licensing and franchising products and services, (3) entering into joint ventures and affiliations, and (4) establishing overseas production facilities and/or acquiring foreign firms (Doole & Lowe 2008). Exporting continues to be important for most firms participating in the international economy. Exports, however, can be slowed by tariffs and quotas. Licensing also has drawbacks because licenses can be abused by licensees who violate the quality control provisions of the license or who sell in markets not covered by the license. Experienced firms, therefore, tend to establish their positions in foreign markets through subsidiaries in preference to, or at least in addition to, exports and independent licensees (Johansson 2005). 69 When the foreign subsidiary approach proves inadequate to provide the required linkage to overseas markets, technology, and capital, larger firms also resort to various types of alliances with foreign firms, often including potential competitors (Vernon & Kapstain 1991). Thus, in international marketing strategy development, selecting the most appropriate segment in the overseas markets needs to be carefully undertaken as does the creative positioning of one’s offering in that segment. Such strategic development is essential in order to gain competitive advantage and will require not only identification of competitors and their relative strengths and weaknesses but also strategies to confront, bypass or ignore them (Fletcher & Brown 2005). Furthermore, the creation of networks of relationships, both within and between each international market, needs to be explored, as in many parts of the world networks are more powerful determinants of business than the specific advantages of the offering (Fletcher & Brown 2005). It is argued here that through the proper implementation of the above international marketing theories that it will impact the effectiveness of international marketing strategy decisions. 2.2.7 International Marketing Strategy As discussed in Section 2.2.1 on International Trade Theories and Section 2.2.2 on Globalisation, two major forces are shaping the global economy today: political and economic convergence, and market consolidation shaped by information technology. To survive in this complex, changing technological and competitive environment with increasing trade liberalisation and 70 deregulation, businesses must adopt flexible international marketing strategies to compete in the global marketplace. Businesses that avoid international markets or do not have flexible or well-developed international strategies often discover that they face competition not just from aggressive foreign competitors seeking to expand abroad into local markets, but also from internationally oriented domestic businesses (Doole & Lowe 2008). International Marketing Strategy (IMS) considers exploring the many ways in which businesses, both multinational corporations (MNCs) and small and medium sized enterprises (SMEs) might progress to become more committed and effective in international markets. They must respond to the needs and demands of customers located in many different countries and are influenced by many different cultures. At the same time, they must cope with competition and gain competitive advantage in each of their markets (Fletcher & Brown 2005). Hence, success in international marketing is achieved through being able to integrate and appreciate the interaction between various elements of analysis, development and implementation of the international marketing strategy development process (Doole & Lowe 2008) as depicted in Figure 2.6 on the next page. Moreover, several researchers have confirmed that international marketing strategic issues can contribute significantly to the success of export marketing performance (Aaby & Slater 1989; Cooper & Kleinschmidt 1985; Crespy et al. 1993; Julian & Ahmed 2005; Koh 1991; Leonidou et al. 2002; 71 Louter et al. 1991; Lu & Julian 2008; Ogunmokun & Ng 2004; Thirkell & Ramadhani 1998; Zou & Stan 1998). Figure 2.: The International Marketing Strategy Process Understand the environmental influences on a firm’s international markets Develop appropriate international marketing strategies, planning and control processes Decide marketing entry strategies Feedback and reassess continuously Segment international markets, identify and analyse opportunities Build added-value through effective marketing mix strategies Using enabling technologies Source: Adapted from Doole & Lowe (2008) In the development process of international marketing strategies, Doole (2000) identified three major components to the strategy of successful businesses competing in international markets: (1) A clear international competitive focus achieved through a thorough knowledge of the international markets, strong competitive positioning and a strategic perspective which is truly international. 72 (2) An effective relationship strategy achieved through strong customer relations, a commitment to quality products and services and a dedication to customer services throughout international markets. (3) Well managed organisations with a culture of learning. Firms that are innovative and willing to learn, show high levels of energy and commitment to international markets and have effective monitoring and control procedures for all their international markets. In formulating strategy, the business must distinguish between purpose and constraints; what it must do in order to survive (Doole & Lowe 2008). The purpose of most firms evolves over time and some might eventually encompass the idea of serving customers in the international markets. The firm's purpose defines the product or services, the markets to be targeted, the type of positioning to be achieved and the values that guide the organisation's behaviour. Thus, a well-defined firm purpose gives long-term directional stability to the organisation and the more focused the purpose is, the more likely it is that a business will be able to develop a successful strategy. Strategic approaches to international marketing by some businesses is through a process of incrementalism based on an opportunistic response to market development, rather than as a strategic choice to grow profitably through internationalisation (Bradley 2005). For these businesses competing in international markets, the reluctance to compete on strategic terms rather than on the basis of increments is understandable. Strategic success depends on an understanding of the culture and competitors in the foreign market and the possession of positive perceptions within the organisation. As such, this 73 evolutionary and expedient process results in small changes which produce short-term results without long-run consequences (Bradley 2005). In contrast, the requirement for firms seeking to survive in international markets is to adopt a revolutionary or strategic perspective on international competition (Mitchell & Bradley 1986). This strategic approach implies that there are uncommitted resources in the organisation that may be dedicated permanently to uses that have a long-term reward. It also implies that management has the training and skills to predict risk and return with sufficient accuracy and confidence to justify the commitment of such resources. Finally, as stated by Mitchell and Bradley (1986), strategic competition is comprehensive in its commitment; it involves the dedication of the whole firm which means that businesses as a whole must act deliberately to make the commitment to invest in international markets. Hence, the meaning of strategy for the international firm refers to an integrated set of actions taking account of the organisation's resources and aimed at increasing the long-term well-being of the organisation through securing a sustainable advantage with respect to its competition in serving its customer needs in domestic and international markets (Bradley 2005). Therefore, as businesses in international markets operate in an environment of opportunities and threats, it is necessary to develop appropriate international marketing strategies configured to compete with other firms while providing value to customers. In such circumstances, the firm can respond by developing standardised products or by adapting existing products to the needs of customers in both domestic and international 74 markets. In general, there are two generic international marketing strategies as depicted in Figure 2.7. Figure 2.: Generic International Marketing Strategies Generic International Marketing Strategies Same Strategy Different Strategy • existing resources • avoid market entry barriers • avoid direct competition • change strategy / add value • product-market differentiation • customisation • global integration • global standardisation Source: Adapted from Bradley (2005). These generic international marketing strategies include ways of entering foreign markets that are broadly similar to strategies used in the domestic market and other strategies adapted for various reasons to the requirements of foreign markets. Over the past four decades, marketing scholars have sought to classify the international marketing strategies of multinational organisations (Keegan 2001; Ozsomer & Prussia 2000; Theodosiou & Leonidou 2003). For the most part, the literature has characterised international marketing strategy into one of the three perspectives of standardisation-adaptation, concentrationdispersion, and integration-independence (Zou & Cavusgil 2002). The most common characteristic of international marketing strategy is along the standardisation-adaptation perspective (Jain 1989). However, there 75 is considerable debate in the marketing literature on standardisation versus adaptation or the appropriateness of global versus niche strategies (Bartels 1968; Buzzell 1968; Levitt 1983; Quelch & Hoff 1986; Ryans et al. 2003). One school of thought argues for a standardised approach to international markets. A standardisation strategy is characterised by the application of uniform marketing mix elements (i.e., product design, pricing, distribution, promotion etc.) across different national markets. Accordingly, a standardised approach is desirable because a consistency in customer dealings, product image and exploitation of a universal appeal across different geographic markets may increase sales (Jain 2004). Furthermore, costs can be lowered by amalgamating production activities without sacrificing quality and obtaining economies of scale associated with developing and implementing a single standardised marketing plan (Buzzell 1968; Levitt 1983; Szymanski et al. 1993; Walters 1986; Yip 1989). Other supporters of this view include Rutenberg (1982), Henzler and Rall (1986), Jain (1989), Zou, Andrus, and Norvell (1997), Laroche, Kirpalani, Pons, and Lianxi (2001) and Chung (2003) who provide various arguments particularly on scale advantages and consistency in marketing planning and actions. On the other hand, an adaptation or differentiated strategy is characterised by the tailoring of marketing mix elements to the needs of each market and the differentiated approach argues that because few markets are exactly alike, it is necessary to adapt the marketing mix to ensure that sufficient customisation exists to satisfy buyer needs in each market (Quelch & Hoff 1986; Wills et al. 1991). 76 Other supporters of adaptation or differentiated strategy include Boddewyn, Soehl, and Picard (1986), Kotler (1986), Douglas and Wind (1987), Ohmae (1989), Sheth (1986), Albaum and Tse (2001), Leonidou, Katsikeas and Samiee (2002), O’Cass and Julian (2003), Ogunmokun and Wong (2004), and Julian and Ahmed (2005) who provide various arguments revolving around the barriers to marketing strategies standardisation in international markets, including governmental and trade restrictions, intercountry differences in marketing infrastructure, product usage, pricing and promotional policies. Because of the conspicuous amount of debates on both views, the literature in the 1980s and 1990s began to treat standardisation and adaptation of international marketing strategy as fixed mutually exclusive options. As such, several publications during this period (Quelch & Hoff 1986; Samiee & Roth 1992; Solberg 2000; Szymanski et al. 1993) suggested that the academic community had come to accept the concept of international marketing strategy as falling along the line of standardisation versus adaptation. Hence, this debate between standardisation and adaptation in the study of international marketing strategy remained largely unanswered. The second concentration-dispersion perspective is rooted in Porter's (1986) design framework and reflected in the Craig and Douglas (2000) Theory of Configural Advantage. Porter (1986) design framework argued that multinational firms should seek an optimal value-chain configuration by fully exploiting its scale and national comparative advantages, yet balancing responsiveness to its local needs. As such, this second perspective is more 77 concerned with the geographic design of the international marketing organisation (Roth 1992; Roth et al. 1991). Craig and Douglas (2000) further described the configuration of marketing value-chain activities of different concentration-dispersion levels, the development of cross-country learning and market-sensing capabilities and explained how all these could influence the cohesiveness of the operational inter-linkages across international markets. With the combination of these outcomes, it will in turn determine the configural advantage of the firm. Therefore, the second concentration-dispersion perspective of international marketing strategy is differentiated according to the extent to which one or more aspect of the marketing value chain are being consolidated or concentrated at particular geographic locations, or being scattered or dispersed across various country markets. The third integration-independence perspective is heavily influenced by Hamel and Prahalad (1985). It involved the extent to which the multinational marketing organisations can orchestrate their competitive moves and strategies on an international basis like leveraging their competitive position in one country to achieve an advantage in other countries, such as by crosssubsidising their promotional campaigns across different international markets. Thus, the key point of the integration-independence perspective is whether the multinational marketing organisations treat its subsidiary units as standalone profit centres (i.e., independently), or as parts of a grander strategic design (i.e., as integrated group of business units). 78 Up until recently, marketing scholars have been relying on a unidimensional scheme to discuss international marketing strategy, or arguing about it by means of a single perspective. Noting on this three-fold perspectives of international marketing strategy, Zou and Cavusgil (2002) attempted to unify the concept by developing a measure that reflects international marketing strategy multi-dimensional nature by proposing a construct, termed the GMS. This construct includes all dimensions of international marketing strategy spanning the three broad perspectives for any multinational firm's international marketing strategy. The GMS concept attempts to create a single aggregate score with the given degrees of standardisation, concentration, and integration in the multinational marketing organisation. With the GMS construct and using a single index, it attempts to capture the overall globalness of an organisation's international marketing strategy. While this concept has many limitations, it does represent a significant step toward a multi-dimensional approach in the study of international marketing strategy (Zou & Cavusgil 2002). However, it was Lim, Acito, and Rusetski (2006) who proposed a holistic and multi-dimensional approach grounded in organisational configurational theory to the characterisation of international marketing strategy. According to the Configurational Theory of Organisations (Meyer et al. 1993; Miller 1981; 1986; 1996), a firm effectiveness is a product of superior combinations of strategic and structural characteristics (Doty et al. 1993; Ketchen et al. 1997; Miller & Mintzberg 1983). In keeping with this configurational viewpoint, their approach is grounded on the premise that any concept of strategy is inherently multi-dimensional, and that various elements 79 of strategy can interact or combine differently in multi-dimensional space (Lim et al. 2006). This approach takes into account the different ways in which any given international marketing strategy can be characterised into multi-dimensional archetypes, taking into consideration the standardisation-adaptation, concentration-dispersion, and integration-independence perspectives, as well as consider the overall configurational pattern of the strategy, in terms of its position along the different dimensions. Hence, to describe international marketing strategy, Lim, Acito, and Rusetski (2006, p. 503) advocated that “one must look beyond single strategy dimensions for modal combinatorial patterns across multiple dimensions”. Based on their holistic multi-dimensional conceptualisation of international marketing strategy and combining patterns of eleven theory based dimensions of standardisation-adaptation, concentration-dispersion and integration-independence perspectives, three distinct international marketing strategy archetypes were presented: (1) Global Marketers, (2) Infrastructural Minimalists, and (3) Tactical Coordinators (Lim et al. 2006). The Global Marketers have a greater degree of standardisation in product design, pricing, branding, advertising and sales promotion. It is more concentrated in its marketing value chain design, particularly in logistics and distribution channels. At the same time it is more integrated in its competitive process such as decision making, communication and mutual consultation across business units in various countries (Lim et al. 2006). On the other hand, the Infrastructural Minimalists pursue a selective approach to standardisation, concentration and integration policies with 80 emphasis on the provision of infrastructure to their local units and minimal inference on their operations. Brand name and channel design are more standardised. However, advertising and sales promotions, pricing and product design are more localised. Similarly, its product design and development as well as its distribution and logistics planning functions are concentrated, but its advertising and promotional planning function is more geographically dispersed. Finally, they are less integrated in its decision making, communication and mutual consultation across country units (Lim et al. 2006). Likewise, the Tactical Coordinators pursue a mixed standardisation policy where sales promotion tactics are moderately standardised, but its product design, advertising theme, pricing policy, and especially distribution channel design are more localised. However, marketing functions like product design and development, distribution and logistics, and advertising and promotional planning are more dispersed. It is more integrated in its competitive process of communication and mutual consultation, but not in its decision-making process (Lim et al. 2006). In summary, international marketing strategy issues are key factors that can affect the performance of exporters in international markets. International marketing strategy of the multinational marketing organisation had been characterised by many different viewpoints from a single dimensional aspect of standardisation-adaptation, concentration-dispersion, and integration-independence perspectives; to multi-dimensional construct of GMS using a single index to quantify the overall globalness of its international marketing strategy, and the categorisation of international marketing strategy into three distinct archetypes. Thus, it is argued here that an understanding of 81 these international marketing theories will impact the effectiveness of international marketing strategy decisions. 2.2.7.1 Factors Influencing the IMS Development Process There seems to be a number of factors influencing the choice and development of international marketing strategies (IMS). For both MNCs and SMEs, there are market factors that include the environmental trends, the market and industry structure, the customer requirements from different countries, the nature and intensity of local and international competition, and the degree to which the firm can defend its position (Doole & Lowe 2008; Jeannet & Hennessey 2004). Particularly for SMEs, specific firm factors such as availability of resources, the products / services and its generic strategy that has been developed, the stage of their internationalisation, and the firm’s capabilities and its attitude to international development and management of risk are particularly important in the development process of their international marketing strategy (Doole & Lowe 2008). According to Lages (2000), both internal and external factors of an organisation influence the development of the firm’s international marketing strategy and affect its export performance. Some of the issues and factors affecting the development of international marketing strategy for any given firms are depicted in Figure 2.8 on the next page. 82 Figure 2.: Factors Influencing the Development of International Marketing Strategy Ambition and Objectives Growth options & Resources Competencies & Capabilities Attitudes to Risk Stage of Internationalisation Internal Company Factors Government Support Customer base Supply chain International Marketing Strategy Development Market and Industry Factors Public and Private Support Networks Systems Support Competition External Environmental Factors Socio-Cultural Political Legal Economic Technological Source: Adapted from Doole & Lowe (2008) and developed for this research The ambition and objectives of the organisation have a large influence in the development of an organisation’s international marketing strategy (Knight 2000). Strategies that an organisation adopts are also constrained by its past behaviour and actions, especially its history of past investments and its operating routines (Bradley 2005). Management aspirations and perceptions for internationalisation are believed to be a direct determinant of the decision making behaviour on strategy development (Axinn 1998). According to Lages and Montgomery (2004), there exists a positive 83 relationship between export marketing behaviour and the decision maker’s aspirations. Also, the export market orientation of the organisation has a direct effect on the firm’s export performance (Akyol & Akehurst 2003). The business’s resources and core capabilities, particularly those that are distinctive and superior relative to the competition, may become the basis of competitive advantage if they are matched appropriately to market opportunities (Thompson & Strickland 2003) and thus may affect their international marketing strategy. Business resources provide the organisation with a comparative advantage that allows it to develop a competitive advantage in the marketplace. According to Hunt and Morgan (1995), this competitive advantage in turn introduces the possibility of superior quality in the organisation’s products and services and superior financial performance. Research into the impact of the above firm-specific characteristics on international marketing performance of Australian export market ventures by Lu and Julian (2008) confirmed that firm-specific characteristics and export marketing strategy significantly influence the international marketing performance of these businesses. Other researchers also support this finding (Christensen et al. 1987; Moini 1995; Thirkell & Ramadhani 1998). An organisational attitude towards risk also plays an important part in the development of international marketing strategy (Tse et al. 1988). Risk refers to general environmental risk such as political risk, government policy uncertainties, economic, social or cultural environmental uncertainties; industry risk such as product-market uncertainties, competitive uncertainties, changing consumer taste, availability of materials and labour supply; and firmspecific risks such as behavioural uncertainty of employees and customers, 84 credit uncertainties and product liability issues. Any decision in one risk area affects the magnitude of risks and decisions in the other risk areas and thus influences the development of their international marketing strategy (Miller 1992). The internationalisation process of an organisation usually occurs in stages, initially with an export department, then an international division and finally it becomes a global organisation (Griffin & Pustay 2007). It is closely influenced by managerial attributes and decisions (Maitland & Nicholas 2002). An understanding of the significance of management quality and dynamism in formulating and implementing effective international marketing strategies has been well established by Cavusgil and Nevin (1981), Cavusgil and Naor (1987), Cavusgil and Zou (1994) and Lu and Julian (2008). Furthermore, it would appear that many researchers consistently recognise management as the principal force behind the initiation, development, sustenance, and success of a firm's international marketing effort, due to their direct responsibility for and involvement in international marketing decisions (Aaby & Slater 1989; Cavusgil & Zou 1994; Julian & Ahmed 2005; Julian & O'Cass 2004; Leonidou et al. 1998; Lu & Julian 2008; Misenbock 1988; O'Cass & Julian 2003; Ogunmokun & Ng 2004; Zou & Stan 1998). In particular, top management commitment has also been identified as imperative to successful business performance in international markets, particularly during the early stages of internationalisation (Knight 2000; Madsen 1989). Hence, firms in different stages of their internationalisation process develop different strategies which eventually affect the development of international marketing strategy. 85 According to Cavusgil and Zou (1994), international marketing strategy is influenced by both internal (firm and product characteristics) and external factors (industry and export market characteristics) and are the key determinants of export marketing performance. Thus, market and industry factors will influence the development of international marketing strategy and its subsequent export performance. The market and industry factors influencing the international marketing strategy development process include competition, the customer base and the supply chain. An understanding of the strategies of current and likely future competitors, and their strengths and weaknesses, may suggest opportunities and threats for the organisation which allow it to identify an appropriate strategic position to adopt (Doole & Lowe 2008). To establish a strategic advantage over the competition with a viable international marketing strategy, it is important for the organisation to clearly define and select the market it intends to serve. This includes segmenting the market, identifying the customer base within the total market, and concentrating on meeting their needs (Jain 2004). There are many different researchers (Daniels & Radebaugh 2007; Hoffman 1997; Kumar et al. 1993) in this area recommending different decision frameworks for international market selection. However, recent research in international market selection with Australian exporters by Rahman (2001; 2006) highlights that target country’s cost indicators, structural compatibility indicators and policy indicators are some of the key factors considered by successful Australian international firms. 86 The supply chain in overseas markets and industry influences the development of international marketing strategy as distribution networks available in each international market vary considerably (Doole & Lowe 2008). Depending on the product and service offerings, this factor could be important in developing the appropriate international marketing strategy. According to Ling-Yee and Ogunmokun (2001), this supply chain or channel support were found to significantly and positively correlate with export performance of the enterprise. Motivators such as the presence of existing customers overseas, a fast growing profitable market, and barriers such as tariffs and quotas also affect an organisation’s international marketing strategy development process (Doole & Lowe 2003; Jeannet & Hennessey 2004). Similarly, support networks, particularly for SMEs, based on personal contacts with family, friends, and other business associates, as well as government agencies for support, advice, information and knowledge, have an effect on the international marketing strategy development process (Doole & Lowe 2008) as well as on export performance (Leonidou 1995; Moini 1997; Ogunmokun & Ng 2004). According to Jain (2004), business derives its existence from the environment. Thus, the external environments have some of the most important factors that influence the development process of international marketing strategy. External environmental factors such as socio-cultural, economic, political, legal and technological have an impact on the strategy development process (Doole & Lowe 2008; Jain 2004; Jeannet & Hennessey 2004). 87 Cultural influences have also been identified as significant determinants of international marketing behaviour and export performance (Faaborg et al. 2005; Rugimbana & Nwankwo 2003; Thirkell & Ramadhani 1998). International business and especially marketing is seen as a cultural as well as an economic phenomenon. The elements that go to make up culture in the international marketing environment include the following: language, religion, varying attitudes towards time, wealth acquisition, risk taking, organisation of relationships in the form of social and cultural stratification, family units, level of education, technology and material, culture development in general and aesthetic values (Rugimbana & Nwankwo 2003). Through the analysis of these cultural elements, attempts are made to determine international modes of behaviour and subsequently influence the international marketing strategy development process (Steenkamp 2001). Economic policies are used to influence the allocation of resources in industrial and commercial sectors so as to achieve structural changes in capital, labour and product markets, and to assist domestic industries to respond to international challenges by addressing economic and political issues (Mclver 2002). Such economic policies in the targeted countries in some ways have an effect on the adoption of international marketing strategy. There are two different government (political) policies: the invisible hand and the heavy interventionist role of government that have an impact on the development of international marketing strategy (Jain 2004). In the former approach governments play the role of benign regulators and observers; in the latter the government supplements market forces. Thus, these two 88 political influences will also affect the way some organisations develop their international marketing strategy. The world is in the midst of a series of technological revolutions, so most industries are affected by technological change (Kotler & Keller 2006). To cope with this changing technological environment, marketing strategists must find new ways to forecast the shape of things to come, to analyse strategic alternatives, and develop strategies with longer term implications (Jain 2004). Thus, marketers must be able to recognise the limits of their technology, know what new technologies are emerging, and decide when to incorporate new technology in their products when developing their international marketing strategy (Jain 2004). Apart from specific legislation which comes from political influences, developments in the legal system can also have an important influence on the development of international marketing strategy (Bradley 2005). The shift in focus in a legal and regulatory environment deeply affects the operations of business, whether domestic or international (Doole & Lowe 2008). According to Ogunmokun and Ng (2004), the ability to envisage and handle legal problems in foreign countries was a major attribute in high performing Australian exporters. In brief, the development process of international marketing strategy among international businesses can be affected by a variety of factors including those discussed in this section, and can be summarise as (1) market and industry factors in both the domestic and foreign markets, (2) internal factors of the organisation, (3) external foreign environmental factors, and (4) public and private support networks in the foreign markets. 89 2.3 Hypotheses Developed from the Literature The literature review has drawn on some of the relevant literature to determine how several bodies of knowledge support or contradict current international marketing strategy development models. Table 2.4 highlights the main factors generated from the literature review that should be considered in the development of international marketing strategies. It identifies the bodies of knowledge of various business disciplines that either directly or indirectly supports those factors. Table 2.: Factors to Consider in the Development of IMS Factors Market and industry factors in home and foreign markets Directly Supported By Indirectly Supported By Strategic Management International Trade Strategic Marketing Globalisation International Marketing External foreign environmental factors Strategic Management International Trade Strategic Marketing Globalisation International Marketing Firm’s internal factors Strategic Management International Trade Strategic Marketing Globalisation Management Decision Making Public and private support networks International Marketing Management Decision Making Source: Developed for this research In view of the above literature review and in pursuit of identifying the factors that the international marketers consider in their development of international marketing strategies, the following hypotheses are developed: 90 Hypothesis 1: The consideration of market and industry factors in both domestic and foreign markets are positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 1 is separated into four sub-hypotheses, each of which represents a market or industry factor in both domestic and foreign markets discussed in the review of the literature as follows: Hypothesis 1a: The consideration of market factors in domestic markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 1b: The consideration of industry factors in domestic markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 1c: The consideration of market factors in foreign markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 1d: The consideration of industry factors in foreign markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. 91 Hypothesis 2: The consideration of the firm's internal factors is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 3: The consideration of foreign environmental factors is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 4: The consideration of public and private support networks in foreign markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. A model of the above hypotheses in relation to the development of international marketing strategy is depicted below in Figure 2.9. Figure 2.: Model of the Hypotheses Relating to the Development of International Marketing Strategy H1 - Market and Industry Factors H4 - Support Networks in Foreign Markets Development of International Marketing Strategy H3 - Foreign Environmental Factors Source: Developed for this research 92 H2 - Firm’s Internal Factors 2.4 Conclusion The development of international marketing strategy in an organisation is a managed decision making process carried out at the functional level usually by international or export marketing managers in MNCs and senior managers in SMEs. A review of the literature suggests that there are at least four key factors within the decision making framework that play a significant role in the development process of an organisation's choice of international marketing strategies. These are: (1) market and industry factors at the firm's home country and the targeted foreign countries, (2) internal factors related to the firm, (3) external environmental factors in the overseas markets, and (4) the public and private support networks in the overseas markets. In this study, market and industry factors refer to the customer base, supply chain and competition in both home and overseas countries. Internal factors related to the firm refers to business ambition and objectives; growth options and resources; competencies and capabilities; its attitudes toward risk and the stage of their internationalisation. External environmental factors refer to the socio-cultural; political; legal; economic and technological in the overseas markets. Public and private support networks are defined as Australian government agencies support and private systems support respectively at the overseas markets. Table 2.5 on the next page summarises the above discussion and lists the key factors and their effect on the development process of an organisation's decisions and choice of international marketing strategy. 93 Table 2.: Summary of the Factors’ Effect on IMS Development Decisions Factors IMS Development Decisions Effectiveness Market and industry factors High effect Firm’s internal factors High effect External environmental factors High effect Public and private support networks Medium effect Source: Developed for this research In the next chapter, the most appropriate methodology will be considered and developed to address the research questions and test the hypotheses. 94 CHAPTER THREE Research Design and Methodology Chapter 1 Introduction Chapter 2 Literature Review Chapter 3 Research Design and Methodology 3.1 Introduction Chapter 4 Data Analysis and Research Findings 3.2 Justification for Paradigm and Methodology Chapter 5 Conclusions and Implications 3.3 Research Design 3.4 Ethical Considerations 3.5 Conclusion 95 3 RESEARCH DESIGN AND METHODOLOGY 3.1 Introduction In the previous chapter, an extensive review of the literature involving the identification of the factors influencing the development of international marketing strategy, as well as other related disciplines was undertaken. This established the research questions for the dissertation; that subsequently led to the formulation of specific hypotheses. This chapter will describe and justify the methodology selected to collect and analyse the data and address the research questions. The chapter begins with a justification of the paradigms and methodologies used in this study (Section 3.2). Then the research design and procedures are outlined along with the data collection, survey design and administration, sampling process, data management and analysis (Section 3.3). Ethical issues related to this research are then addressed (Section 3.4) and finally a conclusion is drawn (Section 3.5). 3.2 Justification for the Paradigm and Methodology One of the key factors in the design of the research methodology for this study was the determination of which paradigm(s) to use in addressing the research problem. This section provides an overview of the issues relating to the choice of the research paradigm and justifies mixed methods utilising both the post-positivist and positivist approaches to be undertaken in this research. 96 Guba (1990, p. 17) defined a paradigm as “a basic set of beliefs that guide action”. It represents a worldview that defines, for its holder, the nature of the world, the individual's place in it, and the range of possible relationships to that world and its parts. Paradigms as basic belief systems encompass three elements: ontology, epistemology, and methodology. Ontology raises questions about the form and nature of reality. Epistemology asks about the relationship between the researcher and the research. Methodology focuses on how we discover or create knowledge (McMurray 2006). Guba and Lincoln (2005) identified five competing paradigms in informing and guiding inquiry: positivism, post-positivism, critical theory, constructivism and participatory. However in recent years, mixed methods research as a new research paradigm is receiving increasing interest especially in social and behavioural sciences research (Creswell 2003; Creswell et al. 2003; Johnson & Onwuegbuzie 2004; Tashakkori & Teddlie 2003). According to Creswell and Plano Clark (2007, p. 5), mixed methods research can be defined as “a research design with philosophical assumptions ... that guide the direction of the collection and analysis of data and the mixture of qualitative and quantitative approaches in many phases in the research process”. In the design of business research, mixed methods combining both positivist and post-positivist paradigms are prominent and provide the backdrop against which other paradigms operate (Davis 2005). 97 In the context of designing a research method, a researcher following a positivist paradigm will focus on facts or causes, whereas a researcher following a post-positivist paradigm will focus on the understanding of human behaviour. Research methodology developed within a post-positivist paradigm tends to yield descriptive data and may be aimed at building new theory through observations; whereas methodology developed within a positivist paradigm is often designed for verification and testing of existing theory (Neuman 2006). The positivist paradigm is normally associated with the development of quantitative research methodology and the post-positivist paradigm with qualitative research methodology (Neuman 2006). This understanding of the broad implications of the two paradigms influenced the choice of mixed methods using both post-positivist and positivist approaches to the research problem in this study. Based on the nature of the research problem, the research questions, and hypotheses developed from the literature review, mixed methods using both positivist and post-positivist approaches were undertaken in this study using both qualitative and quantitative analysis to test the research questions that arose from the literature review. This decision is justified on the grounds that the use of mixed methods provide a greater diversity of views and stronger inferences on the research accuracy, and offer a fuller and more comprehensive study (Tashakkori & Teddlie 2003). Hence, it reflects an attempt to secure an in-depth understanding of the phenomenon in question. This combination of mixed methods, empirical materials, and perspectives in the study is best 98 understood as a strategy that adds rigour, breadth, and depth to the research (Flick 1992). Also, according to Johnson and Onwuegbuzie (2004, p. 14), a key feature of mixed methods research is “its methodological pluralism or eclecticism, which frequently results in superior research”. Moreover, mixed methods research provides more comprehensive evidence for studying a research problem than either qualitative or quantitative research alone as mixed methods research provides strengths that can offset the weakness of both qualitative and quantitative research (Creswell & Plano Clark 2007). As positivist and post-positivist paradigms are the extremes of a continuum, they may also be seen as complimentary rather than contradictory (Haridas 1983; Neuman 2006) and the combination of these two paradigms in mixed methods may be appropriate to provide different perspectives to the research to gain a more holistic view of the study (Morse 1994) as well as for testing the objectives of the research (Schwenk & Dalton 1991). In this study, the application of a qualitative research method will attempt to identify and validate the factors influencing the development of international marketing strategy that arose from the literature review as well as provide input for specific constructs of international marketing strategy development in the design of the survey questionnaire with in-depth interviews using qualitative data and the application of a quantitative survey research method to test the hypotheses formulated from the literature review using quantitative data. 99 3.3 Research Design In Section 3.2, the choice of methodology was justified for this research. In keeping with the decision to follow the mixed methods design using both postpositivist and positivist approaches, the next issue to be addressed is the development of an appropriate research design, built around qualitative and quantitative methods, to collect the necessary data to test the research questions and hypotheses developed from the literature review and address the research problem. This section describes both the qualitative and quantitative research design and procedures in detail. A research design is a framework, plan, structure and strategy specifying the methods and procedures used to collect and analyse the data (Zikmund 2003). Research can be classified into basic or applied research and can also be distinguished into three types, corresponding to its functions, directions and situations (Ticehurst & Veal 2000; Zikmund 2003). Basic or pure research attempts to expand the limits of knowledge, verify the acceptability of a given theory or learn more about a certain concept. Applied research on the other hand, is conducted when a decision must be made about a real life problem (Zikmund 2003). The three types of business research are: (1) exploratory research, (2) descriptive research and (3) explanatory or often called causal research. According to Aaker, Kumar and Day (2004), the most common research designs are exploratory, descriptive and causal. On the following page, Table 3.1 summarises the features of each type of business research and Figure 3.1 outlines the design of this research. 100 Table 3.: Types of Business Research Exploratory Research Descriptive Research Explanatory (Causal) Research Functions Discovering evidence and clarifying problems. Finding out, describing what it is. Explaining how or why things are as they are. Directions Gaining a better understanding of the general problem from various dimensions. Describing the characteristics of phenomenon or population. Crystallising problems that lead to identifying information needed for future research. Providing accurate description of the problem but does not provide explanation for the cause of problem. Identifying cause-and effect relationship between variables when the research has been narrowly defined. Conduct during the early stage of decision making when the decision is ambiguous or uncertain about the nature of the problem. Conduct when there is an awareness of the problem but not completely knowledgeable about the situation. Situations Conduct to sharply define problems, even though uncertainty about future outcomes exists. Source: Adapted from Zikmund (2000) Figure 3.: Outline of the Research Design Research Objectives Research Design Stage One Stage Two (Qualitative) Exploratory Research (Identify the causes of Research Problem) (Quantitative) Descriptive Research Explanatory Research (Possible causes of the Research Problem) Source: Adapted from Sekaran (2003) and developed for this research 101 In this study, stage one will undertake exploratory research and stage two will be both descriptive and explanatory as depicted in Figure 3.1. Each of these research types has a distinct and complementary role to play in this study. In stage one, exploratory research is used to gain background information into the research questions and problem, to clarify and identify the causes of the research problem, and to confirm or reject the survey items. Exploratory studies are also used as an input to further research (Malhotra 2006) and are normally flexible, unstructured and qualitative in nature (Aaker et al. 2004). As a broad generalisation, qualitative methodology used in the exploratory research stage is an essential prerequisite to most quantitative methodology used later on in the descriptive and explanatory research stage (Creswell & Plano Clark 2007; Tidwell et al. 1996). Hence, mixed methods methodology was undertaken in this research. In this study, the exploratory research using qualitative methodology of in-depth interviews is used to gain insights into the research problem and questions, and to identify and validate the key factors influencing the development process of international marketing strategy among several successful exporters in Australia as well as to provide input toward the design of the survey instrument. Next, descriptive research using quantitative methodology of an online survey is used to describe the characteristics of the international marketing strategy phenomena. That is, it was used to determine the frequency of occurrence of certain phenomenon through a survey. To minimise errors and 102 maximise reliability, the survey requires a structured questionnaire and a reasonable number of respondents (Sekaran 2003). In accordance to Sekaran (2003) and Zikumd (2003), if this descriptive research fails to establish a direct cause and effect relationship between the variables, explanatory research will then be considered at this stage. This explanatory research would be to provide evidence of a relationship or association between the variables through a survey (Zikmund 2003). It creates a situation in which conditions can be controlled so that the independent variable(s) can be manipulated to test a hypothesis about a dependent variable (Zikmund 2003). This research design follows the mixed methods Exploratory Sequential Design Model postulated by Creswell and Plano Clark (2007) which comprises two distinct stages: qualitative followed by quantitative. Qualitative data are first collected and analysed, the results of these qualitative data help to develop or inform the subsequent quantitative method (Greene et al. 1989). As the second quantitative stage builds on the first, qualitative stage, the two stages are interlinked in the intermediate stage of the study. Moreover, the use of this mixed methods model in the study also combines the literature review with both qualitative and quantitative methodologies for a more holistic approach as shown in Figure 3.2 on the next page. 103 Figure 3.: Literature Review and Research Methodologies Relationship Literature Review Qualitative Methodology Quantitative Methodology Developed the Hypotheses Validating the constructs of IMS theories Testing of Hypotheses Source: Developed for this research In summary, the hypotheses were developed from the literature review. Exploratory research will be conducted initially utilising a qualitative research method of in-depth interviews to validate the constructs of theories on the development of international marketing strategy that arose from the literature review as well as contributing input for specific constructs in the design of the survey instrument. It will then be followed to the next stage through descriptive and explanatory research with quantitative research methods, using an online survey questionnaire to test the hypotheses developed from the literature review. 3.3.1 Qualitative Methodology According to Denzin and Lincoln (2003, p. 36), “a [qualitative] research design describes a flexible set of guidelines that connect theoretical paradigms first to strategies of inquiry and second to methods for collecting empirical material”. The design of this qualitative research approach follows the Nachmias (2000) Theory-before-Research Model as depicted in Figure 3.3 on the next page. 104 Figure 3.: The Theory-before-Research Model Idea Theory Design Data Collection Analysis Findings Source: Adapted from Nachmias (2000) This linear progression model begins with an idea, gathers theoretical information through the literature review, designs a research plan, identifies the means of data collection, analyses the data and presents its findings. As described by Popper (2002), this orientation suggests that one begins with conjectures (ideas) and then attempts to disapprove or refute them through tests of empirical research. The unit of analysis in this qualitative research comprised of individual exporters in Australia. These constituted the data required for the exploratory nature of this research. This data was gathered through semi-structured indepth interviews with a representative sample of the defined population, selected using non-probability purposive maximum variation sampling technique. 105 Section 3.3.1.1 describes the Qualitative Research Objectives; Section 3.3.1.2 Sampling for Qualitative Research explains the selection of interview sample in detail; followed by The Qualitative Interview to be covered in Section 3.3.1.3, and Rigour of the Qualitative Research in Section 3.3.1.4. 3.3.1.1 Qualitative Research Objectives Statement The purpose of this qualitative research is to validate the factors influencing the development of international marketing strategies among successful exporters in Australia, using phenomenological design via in-depth interviews as exploratory research; resulting in a phenomenological description of the theme factors influencing the development process as well as providing input of specific constructs for incorporation into the design of the survey instrument. It is also used to identify any other factors influencing the development of international marketing strategy among successful exporters in Australia that might not have been established in the literature review. 3.3.1.2 Qualitative Research Sampling In qualitative research, it is not vital to adopt a probability sampling technique as is the case in quantitative research. A non-probability sampling technique using purposive maximum variation sampling was used in the initial qualitative research. The key concept for qualitative research is representativeness (McMurray 2006). That is, to what extent are the characteristics of the smaller group similar to some larger population from which the sample is drawn. There are no rules for sample size in qualitative inquiry as according to Patton (2002, p. 245), “the validity, meaningfulness, and insights generated 106 from qualitative inquiry have more to do with the information richness of the cases selected and the observational/analytical capabilities of the researcher than with sample size”. Patton (2002) provided some guidelines for qualitative sampling and suggested that the logic and power behind purposive selection of participants is that the sample should be information rich. However, when sufficient data creates a situation of saturation, that is, no more new information comes to hand, adequacy is attained and this condition occurs irrespective of the sample size. Relatively small samples were selected using purposeful sampling in qualitative research for in-depth study. Table 3.2 summarises the 16 different strategies for purposefully selecting information-rich cases. Because qualitative research and evaluations often serve multiple purposes, more than one sampling strategy can be deployed. The underlying principle common to all strategies is in selecting information rich cases that can provide a great deal about matters of importance and are therefore worthy of in-depth study. Table 3.: Qualitative Purposeful Sampling Strategies Type Purpose Purposeful Sampling Select information-rich cases strategically and purposefully; specific type and number of cases selected depends on study purpose and resources. 1.Extreme or deviant case (outlier) sampling Learning from unusual manifestations of the phenomenon of interest, for example, outstanding successes/notable failures; top of the class/dropouts; exotic events; crises. 2. Intensity sampling Information-rich cases that manifest the phenomenon intensely, but not extremely, for example, good students/ poor students; above average/below average. 107 Type 3. Maximum variation sampling 4. Homogeneous sampling Purpose Document unique or diverse variations that have emerged in adapting to different conditions. Identify important common patterns that cut across variations (cut through the noise of variation). Focus; reduce variation; simplify analysis; facilitate group interviewing. 5. Typical case sampling Illustrate or highlight what is typical, normal, average. 6. Critical case sampling Permits logical generalization and maximum application of information to other cases because if it's true of this one case, it's likely to be true of all other cases. 7. Snowball or chain sampling Identify cases of interest from sampling people who know people who know people who know what cases are information rich, that is, good examples for study, good interview participants. 8. Criterion sampling Picking all cases that meet some criterion, for example, all children abused in a treatment facility. Quality assurance. 9. Theory-based sampling, operational construct sampling, or theoretical sampling Finding manifestations of a theoretical construct of interest so as to elaborate and examine the construct and its variations. 10. Confirming and disconfirming cases Elaborating and deepening initial analysis; seeking exceptions; testing variation. 11. Stratified purposeful sampling Illustrate characteristics of particular subgroups of interest; facilitate comparisons. 12. Opportunistic or emergent sampling Following new leads during fieldwork; taking advantage of the unexpected; flexibility. 13. Purposeful random sampling (still small sample size) Add credibility when potential purposeful sample is larger than one can handle. Reduces bias within a purposeful category. (Not for generalisations or representativeness) 14. Sampling politically important cases Attract attention to the study (or avoid attracting undesired attention by purposefully eliminating from the sample politically sensitive cases). 15. Convenience sampling Do what's easy to save time, money, and effort. Poorest rationale; lowest credibility. Yields information-poor cases. 16. Combination or mixed purposeful sampling Triangulation; flexibility; meet multiple interests and needs. Source: Adapted from Patton (2002) 108 For this research, a maximum variation sampling strategy (purposefully picking a wide range of cases to get variation on dimensions of interest) was used with the view to find some shared patterns of themes and commonalities. To maximise variety, cross-industry participants were selected from the agricultural sector of the primary producer industry; the education sector of the service industry; the ICT sector of the high technology industry; the mining sector of the resources industry; and the measuring instruments production sector of the manufacturing industry. In total, five firms were selected as the sample. One from each industry mentioned above as shown below in Figure 3.4. Figure 3.: In-depth Interviews by Industry Type and Firm Size Businesses for In-depth Interviews Primary Producers Agricultural Services Education Manufacturing Instruments High Technology ICT Source: Developed for this research 109 Resources Mining 3.3.1.3 The Qualitative Interview There are three main primary data collection (PDC) techniques in qualitative research (Davis 2005). Active PDC techniques include individual in-depth interviews and group in-depth interviews, also known as focus groups and passive PDC techniques use observations. In this research, individual indepth interviews were conducted with key decision makers (CEO, managing director, international marketing manager, marketing manager, export manager or anyone selected by them as suitable to represent the organisation) of the previously selected sample firms. In this research, each of the selected participants was interviewed once and this involved lengthy, semi-structured open-ended interview items employing Patton’s (2002) general interview guide (see Appendix 2) at their place of work. In a semi-structured open-ended interview, the interviewer attempts to have the informant respond to a fixed sequence set of questions planned in advance. It essentially asks the same questions across all the selected respondents. Probing questions are also placed at appropriate places in the interview to elicit more detailed responses. Because the purpose of semi-structured interviewing is to gain information from a similar set of questions from the selected participants, the researcher’s effect and judgement on the interview is minimised and data analysis is easier because it is possible to locate each informant’s answer to the same question quickly (Patton 2002). The strength and weakness of the semi-structured standardised openended interview is highlighted in Table 3.3 on the next page. 110 Table 3.: The Semi-structured Interview Approach Characteristics Topics and issues to be covered are specified in advance, in outline form; interviewer decides sequence and wording of questions in the course of the interview. Strengths The outline increases the comprehensiveness of the data and makes data collection somewhat systematic for each one. Logical gaps in data can be anticipated and closed. Interviews remain fairly conversational and situational. Weaknesses Important and salient topics may be inadvertently omitted. Interviewer flexibility in sequencing and wording questions can result in substantially different responses from different perspectives, thus reducing the comparability of responses. Source: Adapted from Patton (2002) As stated by Morse (1994, p. 225), “qualitative research is only as good as the investigator”. Accordingly, maximum care was taken to ensure meticulous documentation, methodical filing, and up-to-date notes. Advanced preparations provided the researcher with knowledge about the informant's business and their operations, so that subtle clues in the interviews could be picked up and explored. Some interviews were tape recorded with prior approval from each interviewee in accordance with SCU HREC ethics protocol (ethical issues are discussed in Section 3.4). However, as agreed with the participants, all of them were destroyed after being transcribed. Tape recording was used as a method of recording data because of the following advantages: (1) Provides a completely accurate record of what each person said. (2) Frees the interviewer to listen and respond more rapidly. (3) Allows better eye contact and hence better development of rapport between interviewer and interviewee (Berg 2007). 111 Before commencement of each interview, an Information Sheet for the Interview was handed to the respondent and explained. Also, an Informed Consent for Interview form was signed by each interviewee to meet the requirements of SCU HREC ethics protocol. 3.3.1.4 Rigour of the Qualitative Research Ensuring rigour in qualitative research is intricately linked to the establishment of trustworthiness (Lincoln & Guba 1985). According to Merriam (1997, p. 120), trustworthiness of qualitative research is derived from the “…researcher’s presence, the nature of the interaction between researcher and participants, the triangulation of data, the interpretation of perceptions and rich, thick description”. There are numerous approaches to ensuring rigour in qualitative research. The best approach is to construct research designs that push the researcher towards becoming aware of the strengths and weaknesses of the various research approaches (McMurray 2006). As Cronbach argues in Lather (1986, p. 67) the purpose of establishing creditability “is not to support an interpretation, but to find out what might be wrong with it. A proposition deserves some degree of trust only when it has survived serious attempts to falsify it”. Trustworthiness in qualitative research is bound with credibility, transferability, dependability and confirmability according to Lincoln and Guba (1985). In this study, trustworthiness of the qualitative research was established based on credibility instead of internal validity through checking with participants whether their realities were represented appropriately; 112 transferability instead of external validity through the ability to replicate findings; dependability instead of reliability by using triangulation of data and confirmability instead of objectivity by disclosing any source of biases. To further ensure rigour in the qualitative research component, criteria of adequacy and appropriateness of data were also confirmed. In qualitative research, adequacy refers to the amount of data collected, rather than to the number of subjects, as in quantitative research. Adequacy is attained when sufficient data has been collected and saturation occurs, and variations are both accounted for and understood. Appropriateness refers to selection of information according to the theoretical needs of the study and the emerging theory (Denzin & Lincoln 2005). 3.3.1.5 Data Management and Analysis Application of data management methods during the study is essential for the efficiency of the research. Transcripts and notes must be easily retrieved, easily cross-referenced, and easily separated from, and linked with, their original sources (Denzin & Lincoln 2008). Normally, the collected information is not immediately available for analysis, but requires some processing. Field notes must be edited and typed up; audiotapes transcribed, corrected and edited (Miles & Huberman 1994). Werner and Schoepfle (1987) noted that a system needs to be designed prior to actual data collection and stressed the importance of a clear indexing system. In addition, five general storage and retrieval functions were carried out as recommended by Levine (1985). (1) Formatting - how materials are laid out, physically embodied, and structured into types of files; (2) Cross- 113 referral - linkage across different files; (3) Indexing - defining codes, organising them into a structure, and pairing codes with specific parts of the database; (4) Abstracting - condensed summaries of longer material, such as documents or extended field notes; and (5) Pagination - numbers and letters locating specific material infield notes. In this research, the qualitative data collected through the in-depth interviews was analysed manually. Coding (indexing) of the data gathered at the qualitative stage was undertaken immediately after each interview to ensure that valuable data was not lost; as advocated by Strauss (2008). Qualitative data analysis as viewed by Miles and Huberman (1994) contains three concurrent flows of activities: (1) data reduction, (2) data display, and (3) drawing of conclusion and verification. Qualitative data needs to be reduced and transformed in order to make it more readily accessible, understandable and to draw out various themes and patterns. It directs attention to the need for focusing, simplifying and transforming raw data into a more manageable form. Data display, the second important stage of analysis is intended to convey the idea that data is presented as an organised, compressed assembly of information that permits conclusions to be analytically drawn. Such displays assist the researcher in understanding and observing certain patterns and themes in the data (Miles & Huberman 1994). After the data have been collected, reduced, and displayed; analytic conclusions might begin to emerge and define themselves more clearly and definitively. Conclusions drawn from recurring patterns apparent in the data 114 must be verified to assure that they are real by carefully retracing the various steps that led to the conclusion (Miles & Huberman 1994). These three streams of analysis activities and the activity of data collection, form an interactive cyclical process as shown in Figure 3.5. Figure 3.: An Interactive Model of Qualitative Data Analysis Data Collection Data Reduction Data Display Conclusions: Drawing / Verification Source: Adapted from Miles & Huberman (1994) Following from the above analytical model, the analysis of the qualitative data gathered from in-depth interviews in this study is discussed in Section 4.2 and the findings presented in Section 4.2.3. 115 3.3.2 Quantitative Methodology According to Neuman (2006, p. 153), “quantitative research addresses the issue of integrity by relying on an objective technology – such as precise statements, standard techniques, numerical measures, statistics and replication”. The design of the quantitative research component of this research followed a linear progression model adapted from Hair, Bush and Ortinau (2003) as depicted in Figure 3.5. Hence, the quantitative research process was organised in four phases by undertaking ten interrelated task steps as shown in Figure 3.6. Figure 3.: The Four Phases of the Quantitative Research Process Phase 1 Phase 2 Determination of Information Research Problem Phase 3 Development of Appropriate Research Design Execution of the Research Design Phase 4 Communication of the Results Source: Adapted from Hair, Bush and Ortinau (2003) In this quantitative research, the ten tasks undertaken were as follows: Phase 1: Task Step 1: Determine and Clarify Management’s Information Needs. Task Step 2: Redefine the Decision Problem as a Research Problem. Task Step 3: Establish Research Objectives and Determine the Value of the Information. 116 Phase 2: Task Step 4: Determine and Evaluate the Research Design and Data Sources. Task Step 5: Determine the Sample Plan and Sample Size. Task Step 6: Determine the Measurement Issues and Scales. Phase 3: Task Step 7: Collect and Process Data. Task Step 8: Analyse Data. Task Step 9: Transform Data Structures into Information. Phase 4: Task Step 10: Prepare and Present the Final Report. These tasks will be described in detail in the following sections. Section 3.3.2.1 states the Quantitative Research Objectives, Section 3.3.2.2 Sampling for Quantitative Research explains the selection of the survey sample. Section 3.3.2.3 Questionnaire Design and Administration follows, then Data Collection in Section 3.3.2.4. Lastly, Data Management and Analysis with a description of some analytical techniques will be discussed in Section 3.3.2.5. 3.3.2.1 Quantitative Research Objectives Statement The purpose of this quantitative research methodology component of the research is to test the hypotheses regarding those factors influencing international marketing strategy development developed from the literature review and validated by the qualitative methodology in the exploratory research 117 component that relate to the effectiveness of the strategy development decisions of successful Australian exporters in overseas markets, via a selfadministrated web-based online survey. The independent variables were defined generally as those key factors that affect the international marketing strategy development process. The dependent variable was defined generally as the international marketing strategy development decisions effectiveness. 3.3.2.2 Quantitative Research Sampling In selecting a valid and efficient sample for this study, a sampling procedure as outlined in the seven stages by Zikmund (2003) was modified and used in this research and is depicted below in Table 3.4. Sampling design decisions are an important part of research design and include both the sampling plan to be used and the sample size that will be needed. Table 3.: Stages in Selection of a Sample Stages in Selection of a Sample Selection of a Sample for This Research Stage 1: Define Target Population Finalists and winners in each category of AEAs Stage 2: Select a Sampling Frame 437 finalists / winners of AEAs from 2003 - 2007 Stage 3: Determine the Sampling Design and Method Probability Sampling using Simple Random Sampling Method Stage 4: Plan procedure for selecting Sampling Units Plan for sample size, accuracy, time, resources, analysis Stage 5: Determine Sample Size 204 exporting firms Stage 6: Select actual Sampling Units Surveyed the 204 firms Stage 7: Conduct Fieldwork Email web-link to the survey questionnaire Source: Adapted from Zikmund (2003) and developed for this research 118 Stage One: The sampling process commences with the identification of the target population, which is specific and relevant to the research project that the researcher wishes to investigate (Sekaran 2003). Incorrect identification and definition of the target population may lead to invalid data and limit generalisation of the research results. Thus, there is a need to correctly identify and carefully define the target population as it is the source from which the researcher is to collect the data (Zikmund 2003). In this quantitative research component, the identified population was defined as successful exporters who were the finalists and/or winners in each category of the annual Australian Export Awards (AEAs). Stage Two: After identification of the target population, a sampling frame was created. According to Zikmund (2003), a sampling frame is the list of elements from which the sample may be drawn, also known as the population. Furthermore, for the research results to be generalised, choosing a correct sampling frame is important (Sekaran 2003). In this quantitative research component, the population was 437 firms. This include exporting firms who were finalists and/or winners in various categories of the Australian Export Awards for the five years from 2003 to 2007, deducting multiple winners, respondents for the pilot study, in-depth interviewees and pre-testing of survey questionnaire participants. Stage Three: The next stage after selecting the sampling frame was to determine the sampling design. Sampling design is the approach used to select the units of analysis for study. Basically, there are only two types of 119 sampling designs, non-probability sampling and probability sampling (Sekaran 2003; Zikmund 2003). A non-probability sampling method is a process in which the selection of sampling units is based on personal judgment. Sample units are selected on the basis of availability/convenience or desire of the researcher (Zikmund 2003). As such, the potential members of the sample do not have an equal and independent chance of being selected. Neuman (2006) categorised nonprobability sampling into seven types, convenience, quota, purposive, snowball, deviant case, sequential and theoretical. A probability sampling method, on the other hand, is a sample selection process carried out in such a way that all members in the population have an equal chance of being selected. Probability samples are preferable because they are more likely to produce representative samples and they also enable estimates of the sample’s accuracy to be made. Neuman (2006) categorised probability sampling techniques into five categories: simple random, systematic, stratified, cluster and multi-stage. In this research, a probability sampling design using a simple random sampling method was chosen. According to Neuman (2006), a simple random sample is created from a sampling frame that uses a pure random process to select cases so that each sampling element in the population will have an equal probability of being selected. In this case, the sample was drawn from the working population frame using a random-number table. 120 Stage Four: After determining the sampling design and method, procedures for selecting sampling units were planned. The sampling plan specifies the operational procedures and methods to obtain the desired sample (Zikmund 2003) and guides the researcher in determining the sample size, the method of collecting data from the samples, the level of accuracy, time and resources and, as a result, minimises potential errors in the sampling process (Sekaran 2003). In this research, the target population was defined as successful exporters who were the finalists and/or winners of each category of the annual Australian Export Awards, the population frame were those finalists and/or winners from 2003 to 2007, and a simple random sampling method was decided. This research used a survey instrument to collect data, within a three week collection period. The data received was checked and adjusted to make ready for coding and transfer to data storage. The purpose of checking and adjusting data is to ensure the completeness, accuracy and reliability of data before analysis (Davis 2005). Stage Five: With the sampling plan in place, the sample size was determined. Sample size is the selected number of people or objects to be chosen to represent the population (Zikmund 2003). The sample size should be large enough to test the hypotheses and address the research question. Too large a sample does not increase the precision of testing the research question enough to warrant the costs and trouble incurred in getting that size sample and too small a sample is not representative of the population (Salkind 2003). 121 According to Sekaran (2003), there are two criteria in determining sample size: precision and confidence. Precision allows the researcher to know how close the estimate is to the true population characteristics. It is a function of the range of variability in the sampling distribution of the sample mean. That is, the closer the researcher wants the sample results to reflect the population characteristics, the greater the precision required and the larger the sample size needed (Punch 2003; Sekaran 2003). Whereas precision denotes how closely the estimate of the population parameter is based on the sample statistic, confidence denotes how certain the results based on the sample statistics will also hold true and reflect the true population characteristics (Punch 2003; Sekaran 2003). However, in research, the theoretical framework has several variables of interest and determining the sample size, by taking all variables into account, is complicated. Roscoe (2004) proposed a rule of thumb for determining an appropriate sample size: it should be larger than 30 and less than 500. On the other hand, Sekaran (2003) simplified the sample size decision by providing a generalised scientific table as a guideline to ensure a good decision model for the sample size in business research. Taking into consideration both Roscoe’s (2004) rule of thumb and Sekaran’s (2003) sample size table (see Appendix 3), the reasonable sample size should be between 201 - 205 firms. In this research, a total of 204 exporting firms, or approximately 46.68 per cent of the sampling frame, were determined as the sample size, which was appropriate for this research and was manageable in terms of size, cost and time. 122 Stage Six: After determining the sample size, a researcher will then select the sampling units, which are the working units that the researcher will select to study before proceeding to conduct the fieldwork (Zikmund 2003). As this research applied a simple random sampling technique, a total of 204 exporting firms were selected to represent the sample units of this research. This sample was drawn from a list of exporting businesses who were finalists and/or winners of the Australian Export Awards from 2003 to 2007, gathered from the websites of the Australian Export Awards, Australian Export Institute, Austrade and the various State and Territories governments. Stage Seven: Once the six stages were complete, the researcher was ready to proceed with data collection. In this research, an online survey instrument was delivered to the selected sample of 204 respondents by email. 3.3.2.3 Data Collection There are several methods used to collect data in business research. Data can be collected in a variety of ways, in different settings - field or laboratory and from different sources (Sekaran 2003). Data collection methods for descriptive and causal research can be categorised into four main categories: (1) surveys, (2) experiments, (3) secondary data studies, and (4) observation (Zikmund 2003). The selection of the data collection method depends on the type of research being conducted, the facilities available, the degree of accuracy required, the availability of time and resources, and the expertise of the researchers (Sekaran 2003). 123 A survey is one of the most common methods used to collect primary data from a representative sample of individuals (Punch 2003; Sekaran 2003; Zikmund 2003). Zikmund (2003) referred to survey as a research technique in which information is gathered from a sample of people by use of a questionnaire. Questionnaire surveys or interview surveys are commonly used to collect data by telephone interview, face-to-face, mail survey and through other communication media. The term sample survey is often used, since the survey is expected to obtain a representative sample of the target population (Salkind 2003; Zikmund 2003). When conducting surveys, the researcher should be aware of various forms of errors as a result of sampling and should attempt to minimise these errors to maximise the information content and provide generalised results (Sekaran 2003). The advantages and disadvantages of some typical survey methods are summarised in Table 3.5. Table 3.: Advantages and Disadvantages of Typical Survey Methods Door to Door Interview Mall Intercept Interview Telephone Interview Speed of data collection Moderate Fast Very Fast Slow Instantaneous, 24/7 Geographic flexibility Limited to moderate Confined High High High, worldwide Respondent cooperation Excellent Moderate to low Good Moderate Varies Versatility of questioning Quite versatile Extremely versatile Moderate Not versatile Extremely versatile Questionnaire length Long Moderate to long Moderate Varies Moderate 124 Mail Survey Online Survey Door to Door Interview Mall Intercept Interview Telephone Interview Item nonresponse rate Low Medium Medium High Software can assure none Possibility of misunderstanding Low Low Average High High Degree of influence High High Moderate None None Cost Highest Moderate to High Low to moderate Lowest Low Mail Survey Online Survey Source: Adapted from Zikmund (2003) In the quantitative research part of this study, primary data was gathered from individuals through a self-administered web-based online survey to address the research questions. This data collection method was chosen because of the following benefits and advantages: (1) An online survey is cost effective, especially when it involves a large sample size and requires multiple reminder postings. (2) Time is saved as the speed of response is almost instantaneous and therefore the data collection period can be shortened substantially. (3) An online survey can be programmed to ensure that no illegal multiple answers to questions are possible. (4) The respondents being managers are independently capable of answering the questionnaire without any assistance. (5) It allows the researcher to gather specific data to answer the research questions. (6) It allows respondents time to think about their replies, which minimises the possibility of researcher bias. 125 (7) Busy managers prefer to answer surveys at their own time and pace. (8) An online survey allows highly confidential questions to be conducted. (9) Business managers prefer anonymous surveys to protect the confidentiality of their business operation. (10) It is appropriate for reaching a geographically dispersed population, as in this study the respondents are spread throughout Australia (Zikmund 2003). The researcher was well aware that an online survey has some weaknesses such as lower response rates compared to other survey methods, due to email spamming problems and deterrence of email penetration by installation of email filters. Furthermore, there is no assurance that the right respondents will fill out the questionnaire or that all questions in the questionnaire will be answered (Zikmund 2003). To overcome these weaknesses, the researcher undertook the following measures: (1) To achieve a high response rate, an introductory email with the University logo from the researcher, together with an Information Sheet for the Survey were sent to each respondent stating the purpose of study, to induce the respondents to participate and provide credibility to the online survey, as well as to meet the SCU HREC ethics requirements. (2) This introductory email states that the data received from the respondents would be kept anonymous and confidential. This was to assure that the respondents’ identities and firm’s information will not be explicitly reported. 126 (3) Efforts were made to call each business in the selected sample to obtain the name and email address of the appropriate manager and whenever possible speak to the manager to let him/her know about the research and the impending survey. (4) An offer to email an executive summary of the findings to the respondents was also used to increase the response rate. (5) Respondents were able to choose to participate and had the right not to complete the questionnaire or to withdraw at any time. (6) Interesting and carefully designed questions to assist and simplify responses, arranging the questions in a structured and a neat looking web-based online survey questionnaire format were employed which can also maximise the cooperation of the respondents. (7) A follow-up strategy, by sending follow-up email to the introductory email and multiple reminder emails to all the respondents was implemented to increase the response rate. 3.3.2.4 Questionnaire Design To collect quantitative primary data, a researcher must design a questionnaire that translates the information needed into a set of specific items, motivates respondents to complete the questionnaire and minimises response error. Therefore, the design of the questionnaire is one of the central stages in the survey research process (Zikmund 2003). As with most steps in the research process, the design of the questionnaire is highly iterative (Sekaran 2003). Because it is an integral part of the research design, the objective is to seek consistency with the other 127 elements of the design, notably the research purpose and the method of analysis (Zikmund 2003). Additional constraints are imposed by the data collection method and the respondent’s ability and willingness to answer items about the subject. For this study, a questionnaire (see Appendix 4) as the quantitative data gathering instrument had been developed following a rigorous development process. In this case, the survey questionnaire was developed based on the principles as advocated by Sekaran (2003) and schematically depicted below in Figure 3.7. Figure 3.: Principles of Questionnaire Design Questionnaire Design Questionnaire Administration Testing goodness of data 1. Principles of Wording 2. Principles of Measurements 3. General “Getup” Content and purpose of questions Categorisation Appearance of questionnaire Coding Wording and language Type and form of questions Length of questionnaire Scales and scaling Introduction to respondents Reliability and validity Instructions for completion Sequencing Classification data or personal information Source: Adapted from Sekaran (2003) 128 According to Sekaran (2003), sound questionnaire design principles should focus on three areas: (1) principles of wording; (2) principles of measurement; and (3) general “getup”. Principles of wording relates to the wording of the items. Principles of measurement refer to planning of issues of how the variables will be categorised, scaled, and coded after receipt of the responses. While general getup pertains to the general appearance of the questionnaire (Sekaran 2003). 3.3.2.4.1 Wording and Survey Items In the principles of wording, it is essential to word the survey items in a way that can be understood by the respondent. Questions asked should not be too long, as respondents tend to get tired or lose interest in answering long questions. The survey items should not lead, or be loaded, to suggest answers to the respondents. The language, the choice of words, the usage of terms and idioms in different cultures is also important in achieving validity of the survey information collected (Sekaran 2003). The construction of the type of survey items and measurement scales used in the questionnaire is essential in determining how the researcher wants each item to be addressed (Sekaran 2003). The type of items refers to whether the items will be open or closed ended. Open-ended items allow respondents to respond to them in any way they choose. Closed-ended items, in contrast, ask respondents to make choices among a set of alternatives provided by the researcher (Zikmund 2003). 129 The survey items developed for this research all consist of closedended questions, with a total of 40 items, in which the respondents were asked to choose the one closest to his/her own viewpoint. This research chose closed-ended questions to ensure that the alternatives were mutually exclusive and to code the information easily for subsequent analysis (Brace 2004). The sequence of questions and the layout were designed to interest respondents, as these can affect the response rate (Zikmund 2003). The opening items were interesting and simple to comprehend, to warm respondents toward the questionnaire. The layout of the questionnaire should be designed to appear brief, neat, clean and easy to follow, so that respondents can easily understand what they are required to do, so that, in turn, the rate of return can be increased (Zikmund 2003). Demographic questions were asked at the end of the questionnaire, so that by the time the respondent reached the end, he or she would have been convinced of the legitimacy and genuineness of the questions, and hence would be more inclined and amenable to share information (Sekaran 2003). In this online web-based survey, many of the qualitative data findings gathered from the in-depth interviews were incorporated into the design of the survey questionnaire, particularly those specific constructs on the development of international marketing strategy related to Australian exporters. 130 3.3.2.4.2 Measurement Scales Generally, there are four types of measurement scales: nominal, ordinal, interval and ratio scales. A nominal scale, sometimes called categorical scale, is the simplest type but has no intrinsic ordering. An ordinal scale is similar to a nominal scale, but the difference between the two is that there is a clear ordering of scales. Even though the order can be classified, however, it is hard to determine whether the space between each level is equal. An interval scale is similar to an ordinal scale, except that the intervals between each level are equally spaced. Ratio scale on the other hand has absolute rather than relative quantities (Zikmund 2003). Besides these four types of scales, there are two categories of attitudinal scales: (1) rating scale and (2) ranking scale. Rating scales have several response categories and are used to elicit responses with regard to the object, event, or person studied. Ranking scales, on the other hand, make comparisons between or among objects, events, or persons, and elicit the preferred choices and ranking among them (Sekaran 2003). In this questionnaire, rating scales using a seven-point Likert scale were used to measure the intensity of the respondents’ attitude in the first section of the questionnaire comprising items that influence the development of international marketing strategy. Nominal and ordinal measurement scales were used in the second section of the questionnaire on demographic particulars to categorise each item in the spectrum. Furthermore, efforts were made to adapt existing measurement scales for specific constructs of international marketing strategy development in the design of the questionnaire. However, all constructs were developed for this 131 research as none could be adapted from previous studies and existing literature including the Handbook of Marketing Scales: Multi-Item Measures for Marketing and Consumer Behavior Research (Bearden et al. 1993) and the Marketing Scales Handbook: A Compilation of Multi-Item Measures (Bruner & Hensel 1992). Besides, according to Aaby & Slater (1989) and Cavusgil & Zou (1994), there is no well-established conceptualisation or measures of relevant constructs in the international marketing literature. The development of these constructs was guided by conceptual definitions advanced in the qualitative in-depth interviews and refined in the pilot study. Initially, in-depth interviews were conducted during the qualitative study with key decision makers (CEO, managing director, international marketing manager, marketing manager, export manager) to (1) verify and improve the relevance of the variables suggested by the literature, (2) validate and modify the scales intended to measure the variables, and (3) devise a procedure that the researcher would use to assign scores to variables. The final survey instrument after been refined in the pilot study contained eight groups of variables intended to measure market factors in domestic markets, industry factors in domestic markets, market factors in foreign markets, industry factors in foreign markets, firm’s internal factors, foreign environmental factors and support networks factors in foreign markets, as well as international marketing strategy development decisions effectiveness and performance. Once the data were obtained, the goodness of data was assessed through tests of reliability and validity. Reliability indicates how stably and consistently the items tap the variable; and validity establishes how well a 132 technique, instrument, or process measures a particular concept (Sekaran 2003). Therefore, reliability and validity are two essential characteristics of a good measurement tool (Zikmund 2003). Thus, the assessment tools that will be used to test the hypotheses must be reliable and valid; otherwise the researcher may act incorrectly in accepting or rejecting the research hypothesis (Salkind 2003). The relationship between reliability and validity is straightforward. A test can be reliable but not valid, but a test cannot be valid without first being reliable. In other words, reliability is necessary, but not a sufficient condition of validity (Salkind 2003). Therefore, the criteria of reliability and validity were considered carefully in this research, since reliability is a necessary condition for validity and only a reliable and valid instrument will yield accurate results. Zikmund (2003, p. 300) defined reliability as “the degree to which measures are free from error and therefore yield consistent results”. Reliability tests the consistency and stability of a measurement instrument (Punch 2003). It is the degree to which a measure indicates its uniformity without bias and hence ensures consistent measurement over time and across the various items in the instrument (Sekaran 2003). Two dimensions that underlie the concept of reliability are repeatability and internal consistency with which the instrument measures the concept and helps to assess the goodness of a measure (Salkind 2003; Sekaran 2003; Zikmund 2003). In the quantitative research component of this research, reliability issues were addressed by carrying out a principal components analysis and calculating the coefficients of reliability or Cronbach’s alpha. 133 The Cronbach’s alpha is a commonly used method to examine the reliability coefficient, within a particular set of items, by correlating performance on each of the items in a test or a scale with overall performance on the test or scale across participants (Salkind 2003; Sekaran 2003; Zikmund 2003). Cronbach’s alpha is computed in terms of the average intercorrelations among the items measuring the concept (Sekaran 2003). The closer Cronbach’s alpha gets to 1.0, the higher the reliability (Sekaran 2003; Zikmund 2003). Ticehurst and Veal (2000) referred to validity as the extent to which information collected in a research study truly reflects the phenomenon being studied. Zikmund (2003, p. 302) defined validity as “the ability of a scale or measuring instrument to measure what it is intended to measure”. If the measuring instrument does not measure what is designed to measure, there will be problems in the research results. Hence, validity is an issue of research concern, because validity determines the confidence researchers have in the results/outcomes of the study. The way that questionnaire items are examined for validity is to observe whether the items focus on the results of the study and whether the results are understood within the context of the research purpose (Punch 2003; Salkind 2003). Several types of validity tests are used to test the goodness of measures, grouped broadly as content validity, criterion-related validity and construct validity. Content (face) validity is a measure of how well the items represent or tap the concept (Sekaran 2003). Criterion validity is the ability of some measure to correlate with other measures of the same construct 134 (Zikmund 2003), and construct validity is the extent to which the results of a test are related to an underlying construct (Salkind 2003). To determine validity, content (face) validity was undertaken in this research study to ensure that the questionnaire designed would collect the required information to address the research questions and research problem respectively. To establish the content (face) validity for this research, previous studies were reviewed to identify possible items to be included in the scale, experts in the research fields were consulted to obtain their comments on the measurement instrument, then the measurement instrument was tested in a pilot study on a group of respondents similar to the population being studied, to ascertain whether revision was needed before modifying the measurement based on the feedback from the pilot study as in accordance to Davis’s (2005) four-step process. 3.3.2.4.3 General Appearance In general appearance or “getup” as referred to by Sekaran (2003), the researcher needs to pay attention to how the questionnaire looks. An attractive and neat questionnaire with an appropriate introduction, instructions, and a well-arrayed set of items and response alternatives will be easier for the respondents to answer (Sekaran 2003). For this survey, the questionnaire was designed in two sections, with a total of 40 items. Words and instruction used were kept simple and understandable to the respondents to assist them to complete the survey. In addition, an introductory email with an Information Sheet for the Survey (see Appendix 5) was sent to introduce the project, the purpose of the survey and 135 the importance of the results from the survey, while assuring the respondent of confidentiality. 3.3.2.5 Questionnaire Pre-testing Before distributing the survey questionnaire, pre-testing was carried out to ensure that the items were understood by the respondents, and that there were no problems with the wording or measurements. Zikmund (2003) referred to pre-testing as a trial run with a group of respondents, used to screen out problems in the instructions or design of a questionnaire. In other words, pre-testing serves as a trial run of the survey questionnaire to see whether or not it is in need of further revision. The pre-testing sample can be a group of respondents selected on a convenience basis but they need to be similar in makeup to the population that ultimately will be sampled (Zikmund 2003). Hence, pre-testing respondents should not be divergent from the actual respondents, so that the results of the pre-test will assist the researcher to see whether the questionnaire meets the objectives of the research. In this research, the draft questionnaire was tested on a small sample of four respondents before the pilot study to identify and eliminate potential problems. All aspects of the questionnaire were tested, including item content, wording, sequence, form and layout, item response difficulty and instructions. The respondents in the pre-test were similar to those who were later included in the actual survey in terms of background characteristics, and familiarity with the topic. All respondents held positions of responsibility in international marketing. In other words, respondents for the pre-test and then for the actual 136 survey were drawn from the same population. However, care was taken so that none of the pre-tested respondents became part of the final survey. To refine the questionnaire, draft copies were also circulated among three academic experts in the field for comments and feedback. The final questionnaire (see Appendix 4) was designed on the basis of the results of the pre-test and the observations, comments, and recommendations of the academic experts. 3.3.2.6 Pilot Study A pilot study was conducted to determine the feasibility of the online quantitative survey before launching the full scale survey operation. Pilot studies help the researcher gain valuable insights into the process and make necessary adjustments to avoid future problems (Zikmund 2003). The pilot study was planned for this research for the following reasons: (1) To ensure proper design of the questionnaire. (2) To ascertain whether each variable of the questionnaire taps the construct. (3) To assess adequacy of the research method and protocol. Web-based survey questionnaires were emailed to 20 managers of exporting firms in different industries for completion. Follow-up phone calls were made to these managers to increase the response rate, by reminding the respondents to participate and expedite the return process. The results and feedback from this pilot study were incorporated into the final survey questionnaire. 137 3.3.2.7 Questionnaire Administration In this research, the online survey questionnaire was administered as follows: (1) There were 480 firms who were finalists and/or winners of the Australian Export Awards for the five years from 2003 to 2007. However, some of these businesses had been finalists or winners on multiple occasions; this reduced the list to 466 firms. 20 firms were involved in the pilot study, five firms were interviewed and four firms had pre-tested the questionnaire and therefore were excluded from this list, reducing it to 437 firms. This number represents the population of this study. This research was conducted via an online web-based survey of 204 firms selected randomly from this population. (2) The survey of 204 firms was manageable in size, cost and time. The survey took a total of three weeks for data collection. (3) The respondents in this study were managers in charge of international marketing, export, marketing or another appropriate function in these 204 firms. These 204 firms represent approximately 46.68 per cent of the total finalists and/or winners of the Australian Export Awards for the five years from 2003 to 2007. (4) The questionnaire was submitted to the Southern Cross University Human Research Ethics Committee for approval according to the University’s code of research ethics. The research questionnaire was approved on June 2, 2008. HREC approval number ECN-08-057. (5) An introductory email with the University logo together with an Information Sheet for the Survey was sent to each respondent on 15 July 2008 (see Appendices 5 and 6). These described the details of the 138 study, some general instructions and encouraged the respondents to participate via an integrated web link to the online survey. (6) On the third day, 18 July 2008, an email was sent as a follow-up to the introductory email with an integrated link to the survey (see Appendix 7). This was done after three days so the respondent’s memory was still fresh about the request to participate in the survey when he/she received the first email. (7) A week after sending the first email, on 22 July 2008, a reminder email with an integrated link to the survey was dispatched to remind the respondent to participate in the survey (see Appendix 8). (8) On 29 July 2008, two weeks after the introductory email was dispatched, another email with an integrated link to the survey was again sent to remind the respondent to participate (see Appendix 9). (9) Three weeks after the introductory email was sent, on 5 August 2008 the data collection stage was concluded. A total of 54 questionnaires were returned with six responses not fully completed, thus providing 48 usable valid responses for data analysis. (10) The collected data was coded, tabulated and entered into SPSS data analysis software for further analysis. 3.3.2.8 Data Management and Analysis The objective of applied business research is to address some social or practical problem and to identify whether the desired outcomes were achieved and to establish an understanding or explanation (Sekaran 2003). 139 The research design specified the methods that were transferred into action in collecting the data. Such raw data cannot be used to reach conclusions or make decisions until it is converted into information in a format suitable for decision-making (Zikmund 2003). The procedures in converting raw data into information include editing, coding, data entry and data analysis; as depicted in Figure 3.8. Figure 3.: Overview of the Stages in Quantitative Data Analysis Stage 2 Coding Stage 3 Data Entry Error checking and verification Stage 1 Editing Stage 4 Data Analysis Source: Adapted from Zikmund (2003) Editing involves a process of checking and adjusting the data and making it ready for coding and entry into data storage. The purpose of editing is to ensure the completeness, consistency and reliability of data (Zikmund 2003). There are two types of editing: field editing and in-house editing. Field editing is conducted when using interviewing methods, while in-house editing investigates the results of data collected in survey questionnaires (Zikmund 2003). 140 In this research, upon receiving the survey results, in-house editing was carried out to check for errors and omissions in the questionnaires, and if required, adjustments were made to make the data more complete, readable and consistent before coding. Coding is the process of identifying and classifying each response from the questionnaires with a numerical score or other character symbol, then transcribing these scores or symbols into the computer (Sekaran 2003; Zikmund 2003). There are two procedures in coding pre-coded questions and open-ended questions. The code of pre-coded questions is numbered against the responses. Where the response is already a number, there is no need to recode. Generally, only one response is possible for pre-coded questions, therefore only one code is recorded. In the case of open-ended items, a small sample of a total number of replies to a particular item may be tallied to construct categories for coding (Ticehurst & Veal 2000). The decisions about how many categories are acceptable depend on the purpose of the study and the limitations of the computer program and the plan for data entry (Zikmund 2003). In this survey, pre-coded items were used. A numerical score was assigned to each response. Because the questions are closed-ended, the respondent was asked to select only one response that was closest to his/her opinion for each item where the code was assigned. After completing the editing procedures, the code for each answer was then transferred to data storage. Zikmund (2003, p. 467) defined data entry as “a process of transferring data from a research project to computers”. Transferred data includes 141 responses that are edited and coded from the survey questionnaire. There are several means of entering data into computers, such as optical scanning, directly entering data at the moment of collection, and manually keyboarding (Sekaran 2003). When using a keyboarding process to transfer data, the researcher must be aware that errors can occur. To ensure accuracy in transferring data, the process of verifying data should be carried out by a second keyboard operator, who is different from the original keyboard operator, so as to check the accuracy of data entered (Zikmund 2003). However, in this research the data were transferred directly from the downloaded spreadsheet format file of the online survey results, directly into the data analysis software for further analysis. Therefore, the checking of data accuracy by a second keyboard operator was not necessary. Once the data were edited, coded and entered into the computer; data analysis was undertaken. Analysis is the application of reasoning to understand and interpret the data that has been collected about the subject (Zikmund 2003). Sekaran (2003) determined the three basic objectives in data analysis as: (1) To get a feel for the data which will give preliminary ideas of how good the scales are and how well the coding and entering of data have been done. (2) To test the goodness of data in term of reliability and validity, and (3) To test whether the hypotheses are substantiated. In this quantitative part of the research, the analytical tools used to analyse the collected data were descriptive statistics and inferential statistics. Descriptive and inferential statistics are quite different from one another, but 142 work hand in hand. Descriptive statistics are used to describe or summarise information about the characteristics of the sample (Salkind 2003; Zikmund 2003). After the descriptive analysis stage, inferential statistics were undertaken (Sekaran 2003; Zikmund 2003). Inferential statistics are used to make inferences or judgments about a population on the basis of a sample (Zikmund 2003). Inferential statistics also help to establish relationships among variables, in which conclusions are drawn and decisions made as to whether the collected data relates to the original hypotheses (Salkind 2003). To undertake both descriptive and inferential statistics for this research, quantitative data analysis software SPSS for Windows version 14.0 was used to carry out various statistical tests, and to make comparisons between variables and relationships between variables. Table 3.6 summarises the types of statistical tests that can be used depending on the relationship of variables in the research questions, the measurement scales and the number of variables involved. Table 3.: Types of Statistical Tests Research Question 1. Is one variable related to another variable? Variable A Variable(s) B Statistical Test Nominal or Ordinal Nominal or Ordinal Contingency Table Analysis Nominal scale with 2 categories (dichotomous) Interval or Ratio and satisfy assumption of normality Analysis of Variance (ANOVA) or independentsamples t test Nominal or Ordinal Interval or Ratio and satisfy assumption of normality Analysis of Variance (ANOVA) 143 Research Question 1. Is one variable related to another variable? Variable A Variable(s) B Statistical Test Nominal scale with 2 categories (dichotomous) (a) Ordinal, or (b) Interval or Ratio and FAIL to satisfy assumption of normality Mann-Whitney U test Nominal scale with more than 2 categories (a) Ordinal, or (b) Interval or Ratio and FAIL to satisfy assumption of normality Kruskal-Wallis test Ordinal Ordinal Spearman's Rankorder correlation (Spearman's rho) or Kendall's tau Interval or Ratio and satisfy assumption of normality Interval or Ratio and satisfy assumption of normality (a) Pearson Product Moment Correlation and the coefficient of determination (b) Linear Regression 2. Is one variable related to two or more other variables? 3. Have things changed since last time I measured them? Interval or Ratio and FAIL assumption of normality Interval or Ratio and FAIL assumption of normality Nominal or Ordinal Interval or Ratio and satisfy assumption of normality, and Dichotomous Nominal scale Spearman rank order correlation (a) Multivariate analysis of Variance (MANOVA) (b) Discriminant Analysis Nominal or Ordinal Nominal, Ordinal, or Interval/Ratio scales which FAIL assumption of normality Logistic Regression Interval or Ratio and satisfy assumption of normality Interval or Ratio and satisfy assumption of normality, and Dichotomous Nominal scale Multiple Linear Regression (MLR) Interval or Ratio and satisfy assumption of normality The same variable is measured a second time and satisfy assumption of normality Repeated measures Analysis of Variance (ANOVA) or pairedsamples t test 144 Research Question 3. Have things changed since last time I measured them? Variable A Variable(s) B Statistical Test Interval or Ratio and satisfy assumption of normality The same variable is measured a second time, and a third time (or more) and satisfy assumption of normality Repeated measures Analysis of Variance (ANOVA) (a) Ordinal, or (b) Interval or Ratio and FAIL to satisfy assumption of normality The same variable is measured a second time Wilcoxon signedrank test (a) Ordinal, or (b) Interval or Ratio and FAIL to satisfy assumption of normality The same variable is measured a second time, and a third time (or more) Friedman test 4. Can I identify a subset of variables which will best predict the values of an independent variable? Independent: Interval or Ratio and satisfy assumption of normality Predictors: Interval or Ratio and satisfy assumption of normality Stepwise Multiple Linear Regression Independent: Nominal or Ordinal scale Predictors: Interval or Ratio and satisfy assumption of normality Stepwise Discriminant Analysis 5. Can the scores on a large set of items be explained by a small number of underlying factors or dimensions? Dichotomous Nominal scale, or Interval or Ratio and satisfy assumption of normality Principal Components Analysis 6. Do sub-groups of people exist in my sample who has similar patterns of responses across a set of variables? Dichotomous Nominal scale, or Interval or Ratio and satisfy assumption of normality Cluster Analysis 7. Can I test a model which proposes causal relationships between a set of variables? Dichotomous Nominal scale, or Interval or Ratio and satisfy assumption of normality (a) Usually a combination of a number of correlation and Multiple Linear Regression analyses. (b) Structural Equation Modelling Source: Adapted from Manning & Munro (2006) 145 To select appropriate tests for data analysis and interpretation, Manning and Munro (2004) suggest a five step process as follows: (1) Understand the purpose of the research such as testing hypotheses, or making a correlation between variables, or testing differences in variables; (2) Identify the variables involved and the exact nature of the relationship expected; (3) Determine the scale of measurements of each variable; (4) Ensure the variables satisfy the assumptions; (5) Select the appropriate tests based on the above considerations. Since the objective of this study was to test whether the research hypotheses are supported or not, that is, to determine whether the seven independent variables (market factors in domestic market, industry factors in domestic market, market factors in foreign market, industry factors in foreign market; firm’s internal factors, foreign environmental factors, and support networks factors) are related to the dependent variable (IMS development decisions effectiveness), a standard multiple linear regression analysis was carried out. Multivariate regression analysis is used to model relationships between variables as well as to determine the magnitude of relationships and to make predictions based on the models. There are three major regression methods: standard, hierarchical and stepwise regression (Coakes & Steed 2007). In the standard method, all independent variables enter the regression equation at the same time, since the objective is to examine the relationship between the whole set of independent variables and the dependent variable. 146 In the hierarchical method, the researcher determines the order of entry of the independent variables based on theoretical knowledge. Finally, for the stepwise method, the number of independent variables entered and the order of entry are determined by statistical criteria generated by the software (Coakes & Steed 2007). As advocated by Manning & Munro (2006) and Hair et al. (2006), in this research, the standard multiple linear regression method was used to determine the relationship between the seven independent variables and one dependent variable in testing the research hypotheses developed in Chapter Two. However, before multivariate regression analysis was carried to test the hypotheses, other analyses were conducted on the collected data. These include exploratory factor analysis using Kaiser-Meyer-Olkin (KMO) measure of sampling adequacy and Bartlett's test of sphericity to assess the factor structures of the data and loadings of items; factor analysis using principal components extraction method to examine whether all the items in each composite variable could be considered to represent a single underlying construct; assessing the values of skewness and kurtosis to determine the normality of the data distribution; and a non-parametric analysis using the Spearman rank correlation coefficient test to verify the significance of relationship between the variables. 3.3.2.9 Limitations of the Quantitative Methodology In regard to the cross-sectional research design used in the quantitative study, some of the limitations are as follows: 147 (1) A common limitation of cross-sectional studies may be due to errors in recall of the event and possibly outcome (Mancuso & Charlson 1995). In any survey-based method, including the online web-based survey adopted in this study, there are bound to involve measurement error. For example, the elicitation of the scale measurement depends on the respondent’s ability to accurately report their level of agreement with the survey statements in the questionnaire regarding their perceptions and attitudes towards the development of their firm’s international marketing strategies. (2) Confounding factors may not be equally distributed between the groups being compared and this unequal distribution may lead to bias and subsequent misinterpretation (Lindell & Whitney 2001; Mann 2003). As in this study, individual weighting assigned by each firm to those factors influencing the development of their international marketing strategies and its measurement scales are not taken into consideration. (3) Data collection was conducted only in Australia and it could be suggested that generalisability of the findings beyond this country may be problematic as Australia is a relatively minor player internationally with less than two percent share of the world GDP and less than one percent share of the annual international trade in 2007 (World Trade Organization 2008). (4) Timing maybe a crucial factor in the development and implementation of an international marketing strategy. However, this study does not examine the time factor and its importance in the development of an international marketing strategy. 148 (5) A further limitation of cross-sectional studies is that it is not possible to establish cause and effect. Cross sectional studies are used to determine prevalence. They are relatively quick and easy but do not permit distinction between cause and effect. Therefore, cross sectional studies do not provide an explanation for their findings (Mann 2003). Furthermore, the use of web-based online survey for data collection has its limitations too. Some of the limitations are summarise as follows: (1) There are tendency that some individuals may respond to an invitation to participate in an online survey, while others may ignore it. Therefore, there is no assurance that the right respondents will participate in the survey, leading to a systematic (self-selection) bias (Thompson et al. 2003). (2) Cannot find out who had or had not responded to the survey as nonresponse rate tracking is difficult to ascertain in most online survey methods (Andrews et al. 2003). (3) Access issues due to email spamming problems and deterrence of email penetration by installation of email filters (Wright 2005). 3.4 Ethical Considerations Ethical considerations are important in academic and business research, as in any other field of human activity (Ticehurst & Veal 2000). There are a number of ethical considerations in the implementation of this research. This section of the methodology outlines a number of the key ethical issues associated with this research, namely harm, privacy, informed consent and research ethics. 149 These ethical issues were addressed in this research by adhering to the Southern Cross University’s code of research ethics guidelines. An application that includes the questionnaire used in this research was made to the Southern Cross University Human Research Ethics Committee for approval according to the University’s code of research ethics, and the application was approved on June 2, 2008, approval number ECN-08-057. In this study, harm relates more to confidentiality of data and privacy rather than physical or other distress (Ticehurst & Veal 2000). Consequently, all interviews and data collected remain confidential, and identities of respondents remain anonymous. Therefore, it is imperative to the success of this research that the respondents understand the level of confidentiality being afforded to them throughout this process. Moreover, the privacy of all respondents is to be respected in the implementation and reporting of this research. No details of individuals involved in this research are published. Informed consent is a written statement that explains aspects of a study to participants and asks for their voluntary agreement to participate before the study begins (Neuman 2006). Furthermore, where there is a risk of harm to the subject, it is clearly necessary for the subject to be fully aware of the risks involved in order to give their informed consent to participate in the research (Ticehurst & Veal 2000). In this study, each participant was provided with an information sheet explaining the purpose of the research prior to each interview and the survey (see Appendix 5). This information sheet described the objectives of the research with contact particulars for further details if required. During the 150 introduction to the interview, participants were informed as to why they were chosen for the research and reminded of the purpose of the research. Finally, all parties involved in this research have obligations affected by ethical concerns. Each participant is obliged to be truthful and provide honest cooperation (Zikmund 2003). The researcher is expected to be truthful in representing the purpose of the research, to be objective and to protect the rights of the participants. 3.5 Conclusion This chapter addressed the mixed methods research methodology adopted for this study. The research design amalgamating the literature review with both qualitative and quantitative approaches was discussed. Appropriate data collection methods were described together with the sample selection procedure and the methodical process. Qualitative research method by means of in-depth interviews was undertaken to validate the factors influencing the development of international marketing strategy that arose from the literature review and to identify any other factors not established in the literature review as well as provide input to the design of the survey instrument. Quantitative research methods via an online survey questionnaire was then undertaken to test the hypotheses developed from the literature review. The survey respondents in this study are all successful exporters who were either finalists or winners in various categories of the annual Australian Export Awards for the five years from 2003 to 2007. A simple random sampling technique was applied to collect data through a self-administrated online web- 151 based survey questionnaire. Once the data was collected, it was checked, coded and input into the computer for analysis. Statistical software package, SPSS version 14.0 for Windows was then used to analyse the collected data and several statistical techniques were explored to analyse the quantitative data, including factor analysis, nonparametric analysis and regression analysis. In the next chapter, the collected data analysis will be discussed and interpreted to present the research findings. 152 CHAPTER FOUR Data Analysis and Research Findings Chapter 1 Introduction Chapter 2 Literature Review Chapter 3 Research Design and Methodology Chapter 4 Data Analysis and Research Findings 4.1 Introduction Chapter 5 Conclusions and Implications 4.2 Qualitative Data Analysis 4.3 Quantitative Data Analysis 4.4 Summary of Research Findings 4.5 Conclusion 153 4 DATA ANALYSIS AND RESEARCH FINDINGS 4.1 Introduction In the previous chapter, a detailed discussion on the research design and methodology applied in this study was carried out. This chapter will now present the data collected from the in-depth interviews and online survey, and provide a detailed analysis of the data collected using both qualitative coding analytical techniques and quantitative statistical techniques identified in Chapter Three to test the four hypotheses developed in Chapter Two. The chapter begins with the analysis of qualitative data gathered from the in-depth interviews together with the findings (Section 4.2), followed by the analysis of quantitative data collected from the web-based online survey (Section 4.3). The profiles of respondents are outlined in the classification of data. Then, preliminary examination of the data, including data screening, forming composite variables, checking for internal consistency, identifying univariate and multivariate outliers, tests for normality of distribution and descriptive statistics is discussed. Next, checking for the presence of common method variance are carried out, reliability and validity issues are addressed, non-parametric analysis to verify the significance of relationship between variables are conducted and inferential statistics used to determine relationships among variables and to test the hypotheses are explored. A summary of the research findings is presented (Section 4.4), and finally conclusions are drawn (Section 4.5). 154 4.2 Qualitative Data Analysis It has been mentioned in Chapter Three that mixed methods research methodology using both qualitative as well as quantitative approaches were used in this study. Traditionally qualitative and quantitative approaches have been positioned as if they were polar and mutually exclusive alternatives. However recently, mixed methods research has emerged that provide a more balanced approach in which both types of researcher admit the contribution of the other (Creswell 2003). In this study, qualitative research methodology was carried out as a prelude to the quantitative research methodology in order to validate the key factors influencing the international marketing strategy developmental process that arose from the literature review and to identify any other factors that might not be established in the literature review that is pertinent to Australian exporters as well as to refine the items for incorporation into the survey questionnaire. This survey instrument was later used to test the hypotheses developed in the literature review of Chapter Two using quantitative research methods. Qualitative data gathered from in-depth interviews was analysed manually following the analytic technique developed by Miles and Huberman (1994). This includes (1) putting information into different arrays; (2) making a matrix of categories and placing the evidence within the relevant categories; creating data displays; (3) tabulating the frequency of different events; (4) examining the complexity of such tabulations and their relationships by calculating second-order numbers through means and variances; and (5) 155 putting information in chronological order or using some other temporal scheme. Accordingly, in this research, the following steps were taken to analyse the data gathered from the interviews using Glaser and Strauss’s (1967) method of constant comparison and Miles and Huberman’s (1994) coding and analytic technique for qualitative data analysis: (1) It began with the reading of the transcripts to obtain an overall flavour of the interviewees’ responses. Next to each sentence or paragraph, labels were generated to reflect the initial coding. From these labels, a general category scheme of the participant responses was developed. (2) Themes were identified by sorting the initial scheme into concrete categories and subcategories. The categorisation reflected similarity of responses and frequency of responses. At least half the participants had to identify an initial theme for it to be included (Miles & Huberman 1994). Next, the transcripts and field notes were re-read, looking for frequently occurring expressions and unexpected counterintuitive material that may provide atypical evidence of participant experiences. The responses were then categorised according to several initial themes. (3) These themes were reviewed to determine how they fit into existing literature or how they might contribute to an understanding of the international marketing strategy development process. During this step, two criteria advocated by Patton (2002) were used: Does the information confirm current international marketing strategy development literature, and does it offer any new insights and 156 interpretations on the development of international marketing strategy? As a result, the initial themes were combined and renamed into factors related to the development of international marketing strategy. The responses were re-read and categorised into one of the nine themes (factors) to ensure goodness of fit. After this step, the researcher should determine whether the resulting nine factors adequately reflect the responses provided by participants. With the above steps undertaken, the analysis of qualitative data gathered from in-depth interviews will be explored in greater detail in the following sections. 4.2.1 Profile of Interview Participants A total of five participants were interviewed in this study, and all were selected from the list of Australian Export Awards winners and finalists from 2003 to 2007. A maximum variation sampling strategy was utilised to select information rich cases across a variety of industries (Patton 2002). All the interviews were undertaken in a two week time frame. Interviews with each of the participants were carried out in their respective offices and lasted between 45 minutes to an hour. Participants were reminded to respond to the questions on the basis of their organisation's practices, rather than what they personally think should be done and that each question should be answered individually on its own merit and not be influenced by response(s) to any other question(s). To protect the confidentiality of the participants, each participant was identified by a code. The details of the organisations they worked for were not 157 identified to further protect their confidentiality and in order to meet the ethics requirements as set by the SCU Human Research Ethics Committee. Table 4.1 summarises the profile of each interviewee together with a brief description of their organisation’s ownership types, years of international business experience, annual international turnover and the industry and sector they represent. Table 4.: Profile of Interview Participants Code Position Industry and Sector Ownership Type Internation al Business Annual Turnover A Marketing Director High Technology – ICT Australian Sole Trader / Partnership 3 - 5 Years Less than A$5 Million B Export Manager Primary Producers Agricultural Australian Proprietary Company 3 - 5 Years A$5 to A$50 Million C International Manager Services Educational Government Enterprise More than 5 Years Less than A$5 Million D Marketing Manager Resources – Mining Australian Public Company More than 5 Years More than A$50 Million E General Manager Manufacturing Instruments Subsidiary of foreign MNCs More than 5 Years A$5 to A$50 Million Source: Analysis of interview data 4.2.2 Data Reduction and Display The in-depth interviews with each participant followed a semi-structured openended interview style with the aid of a general interview guide (see Appendix 2) so that all participants would respond to a fixed sequence set of the same questions and none would be missed (Patton 2002). 158 On completion of each interview, raw qualitative data were immediately coded, formatted and indexed to simplify and transform it into a more manageable structure (Strauss 2008). Following the analytic technique developed by Miles and Huberman (1994), the data were then reduced and displayed in a matrix format showing the frequency of occurrence for each factor influencing the development of international marketing strategy, as well as other information on the development process of their international marketing strategy as shown in Table 4.2. Table 4.: In-depth Interviews Data Display Code A B C D E Total Count % √ √ √ √ 5 100 √ √ 3 60 √ √ 2 40 √ √ √ 4 80 Factors/variables 1. Market Factors in Domestic Markets Competition √ customer base √ lack of growth product/services substitution √ 2. Industry Factors in Domestic Markets controls and restrictions √ √ √ √ √ 5 100 buyer’s bargaining power √ √ √ √ √ 5 100 supplier’s bargaining power √ √ √ 4 80 3. Market Factors in Foreign Markets Competition √ √ √ √ 4 80 customer base √ √ √ √ 4 80 product/services substitution √ √ √ √ 4 80 distribution networks √ √ √ √ 4 80 159 4. Industry Factors in Foreign Markets government controls local / commercial practices √ √ √ √ √ 5 100 √ √ √ √ 4 80 √ √ √ √ 4 80 5. Industry Factors in Foreign Markets barriers of entry 6. Firm’s Internal Factors business objectives √ √ √ √ √ 5 100 competitive advantages √ √ √ √ √ 5 100 attitude towards risk √ √ √ √ 4 80 business’s resources and core capabilities √ √ √ √ √ 5 100 top management aspirations and commitment √ √ √ √ √ 5 100 7. Foreign Environmental Factors socio-cultural practices √ √ √ √ 4 80 political system √ √ √ √ 4 80 legal system √ √ √ √ 4 80 economic climate √ √ √ √ 4 80 technological differences √ √ √ 3 60 2 40 1 20 √ 1 20 8. Support Networks Factors public support networks √ private support networks √ √ 9. Parent Company Factors follow head office guidelines 10. Others – IMS Development Process multi-dimensional strategy √ √ √ √ √ 5 100 IMS modify over time √ √ √ √ √ 5 100 Source: Analysis of interview data 160 Altogether, nine factors influencing the development of international marketing strategy were identified from these in-depth interviews as indicated in Table 4.2 in the previous page. The first eight factors relate to the research hypotheses developed in the literature review in Chapter Two. Although, within the context of this research, the ninth factor that was uncovered during this part of the research was found to be irrelevant to this study because of its specific nature; as discussed in the following chapter (Section 5.6) future research on this specific factor is recommended. This factor was stated by participant E as follows: “Our company needs to follow established guidelines from our regional headquarters in developing our international marketing strategy, like …” This factor seems only applicable to subsidiaries of MNCs which require them to follow their parent company guidelines in their development of international marketing strategy. This factor seems unique to larger organisations where protocol must be strictly maintained for control purposes, unlike smaller SMEs that are much more autonomous in their strategy development. Another irrelevant issue was identified during the in-depth interviews when participants were encouraged to provide further comments. An interesting remark came from participant A: “Because our business is ‘virtual’ … on the World Wide Web, we don’t need to look into any external factors in the foreign markets as we do not know where our customers come from”. 161 As established in the literature review where foreign external environmental factors are always considered in the development of international marketing strategy with traditional businesses, this phenomenon seems completely different for virtual businesses. Thus, further investigation and research on the development of international marketing strategy for this type of businesses may be of value and is discussed in Section 5.6. 4.2.3 Qualitative Data Findings After the qualitative data from in-depth interviews had been collected, reduced and displayed; common key themes and recurring patterns began to emerge. From the analysis carried out using Glaser and Strauss’s (1967) method of constant comparison and Miles and Huberman’s (1994) coding and analytic technique, the following findings are presented: These nine themes - market factors in domestic markets, industry factors in domestic markets, market factors in foreign markets, industry factors in foreign markets, industry factors in foreign markets, firm’s internal factors, foreign environmental factors, support networks factors and parent company factors are dimensions or factors associated with the development of international marketing strategy. As the last dimension - parent company factor relates only to MNCs, the remaining eight dimensions provided a foundation for the development of a measure for the quantitative phase of this mixed methods research. 162 The following findings are the results from the analysis of the above themes: (1) Successful Australian exporters follow a variety of multi-dimensional strategy development processes that differ over time and in different contexts when developing their international marketing strategies. (2) Most exporters take into consideration market and industry factors like competition, customers and supply chain distribution networks both in the domestic and foreign markets when developing their international marketing strategies. (3) All exporters take into consideration the firm’s internal factors such as the ambition and objectives of the organisation, its attitude towards risk, the firm’s resources and core capabilities, and top management aspirations and commitment when developing their international marketing strategy. (4) Businesses that are subsidiaries of MNCs need to follow parent company guidelines in developing their international marketing strategy. (5) For most exporters, foreign environmental factors in particular sociocultural, political, legal, economic and technological factors in the foreign markets have an influence in the development of their international marketing strategy. (6) The public support networks in the foreign markets are considered by some exporters in the development of their international marketing strategy, but most of them rarely rely on private support networks in the foreign markets. 163 (7) Most businesses do not utilise only one development process in formulating their international marketing strategy, but employ multiple development processes of strategy development. (8) The international marketing strategies developed are not stagnant for a fixed period, but modify over time when circumstances change or opportunities present. (9) An interesting observation of an e-commerce company whose business model is virtual, with operations rooted solely on the Internet World Wide Web, is that it does not take into consideration any factors in the foreign markets when developing their international marketing strategy. They do not need strategies to target specific markets due to the fact that the Internet is global in nature. The common key themes in the qualitative data from the exploratory research phase were incorporated into the final survey questionnaire to be tested along with the hypotheses developed from the literature review in Chapter Two. In addition, these findings also validate several key factors influencing the development of international marketing strategy that arose from the literature review. These included market and industry factors in both domestic and foreign markets, the firm’s internal factors, foreign environmental factors, and public and private support networks in the foreign markets. Furthermore, the findings from these in-depth interviews did identify an issue related to the development of international marketing strategy that was not found in the literature review. That is, virtual businesses do not consider any environmental factors in the foreign markets when developing their 164 international marketing strategy compared to traditional businesses. While this type of virtual businesses is extraneous to this study, further research on this unique issue is recommended and discussed in Section 5.6. 4.3 Quantitative Data Analysis In this mixed methods research both qualitative and quantitative approaches were used. Qualitative research was conducted to validate the constructs and linkages between constructs and quantitative research methods were then applied to test those constructs and relationships. In the previous section, results of the qualitative research were reported, and the conclusions of this part of the research were incorporated into the survey instrument to test the hypotheses developed in the literature review. That is, the results of the qualitative research will be subjected to further quantitative testing for validation and generalisation. In this section, the results of the quantitative research will be reported. Before reporting the detailed quantitative analyses, profiles of the respondents are outlined in the classification of data. 4.3.1 Classification of Data In this research, an introductory email with an integrated web link to the online survey and an Information Sheet for Survey was sent on 15 July 2008 to the manager in-charge of the export or (international) marketing department of the 204 Australian exporters who were either finalists or winners of the Australian Export Awards from 2003 to 2007. If there was no such post in the organisation, it was explicitly requested that the managing director, general 165 manager or someone with in-depth knowledge of the firm's exporting activities should complete the questionnaire. A total of 54 questionnaires were received during the three week collection period with six responses not fully completed, yielding an effective response rate of 23.5%. This response rate was considered reasonable, according to Pecotich, Hattie and Low (1999) and Groves (2004) on comparable similar surveys, as busy executives tend to be less likely than the general population to respond to survey questionnaires, and with the current problem of spamming, about 35% of mass emails are expected to be opened by receivers whilst the rest would remain blocked or deleted. As a result, a response rate for an online web-based questionnaire of above 20% is considered to be good (Melon Media 2008). Although this response rate (23.5%) is not high, it was considered adequate for this web-based online survey. Table 4.3 below shows the response rate of surveyed respondents. Table 4.: Response Rate of the Survey Respondents Australian Export Awards Winners / Finalists 03-07 Working Population Sample Size Returned Usable Questionnaire Response Rate 437 204 48 23.5% Source: Analysis of survey data In the distribution of respondents by industry category, there was a good mix of industry categories among the respondent firms, with the majority 166 (37.5%) falling within the high technology sector. Table 4.4 below shows the distribution of respondents by industry category. Table 4.: Distribution of Respondents by Industry Category Industry Category Number of Respondents Percentage High Technology 18 37.5 Primary Producers 4 8.3 Manufacturing 11 22.9 Services 11 22.9 Resources 3 6.3 Others 1 2.1 Source: Analysis of survey data The largest number (66.7%) of the respondent firms had an international annual turnover between A$5.0 to A$50.0 million and only 12.5% of firms had an annual international turnover of more than A$50.0 million. Table 4.5 below shows the distribution of respondent firms by their annual international turnover. Table 4.: Distribution of Respondent Firms by their Annual International Turnover Annual International Turnover Number of Respondents Percentage Less than A$5.0 Million 10 20.8 A$5.0 to A$50.0 Million 32 66.7 More than A$50.0 Million 6 12.5 Source: Analysis of survey data 167 In the distribution of respondent firms by their ownership types, the majority are Australian owned proprietary companies (62.5%). Table 4.6 below shows the distribution of respondent firms by their ownership types. Table 4.: Distribution of Respondent Firms by Ownership Types Ownership Type Number of Respondents Percentage Australian Owned Proprietary Company 30 62.5 Australian Government Enterprise 4 8.2 Australian Owned Sole Trader/Partnership 3 6.3 Subsidiary of a Foreign Multinational 3 6.3 Australian Public Company 8 16.7 Others 0 0 Source: Analysis of survey data The majority of the respondent firms (83.3%) had international business experience of more than five years and none had three years or less. Table 4.7 below shows the distribution of respondent firms by the length of their international business experience. Table 4.: Distribution of Respondent Firms by Length of International Experience Length of International Business Experience Number of Respondents Percentage Less than 1 Year 0 0 1 - 3 Years 0 0 3 - 5 Years 8 16.7 More than 5 Years 40 83.3 Source: Analysis of survey data 168 There was also a good mix in the number of countries where the respondent’s product/services are marketed, with the majority (70.8%) marketed in more than 10 countries. Table 4.8 below shows the distribution of respondent firms product/services by number of countries marketed. Table 4.: Distribution of Respondent Firms Product/services by Number of Countries Marketed Marketed in number of overseas countries Number of Respondents Percentage Less than 3 countries 3 6.3 4 – 10 countries 11 22.9 More than 10 countries 34 70.8 Source: Analysis of survey data In the distribution of respondent firms by mode of market entry, all of the respondent firms are exporters, with some businesses having multiple mode of entry to international markets. Table 4.9 below shows the respondent firms by their mode of market entry. Table 4.: Distribution of Respondents by Mode of Market Entry Market entry mode Number of Respondents Percentage Exporting 48 100 Contractual agreement 11 22.9 Joint venture 4 8.3 Direct investment 8 16.6 Others 3 6.3 Source: Analysis of survey data 169 4.3.2 Preliminary Analysis of Data After the collected data was transferred into SPSS software for analysis, a preliminary examination of the raw data was carried out to screen, and if required, the raw data was cleaned. This is to address two issues: case-related issues such as the accuracy of the data input, homogeneity and reliability of the composite variable on whether it really does represent a single underlying construct and identifying both univariate and multivariate outliers; and distribution issues such as normality, homoscedasticity and linearity (Hair et al. 2006; Tabachnick & Fidell 2007). 4.3.2.1 Data Screening and Entry For this study, the raw data was downloaded from the online survey in a spreadsheet format. Coding was performed to transform the downloaded character values to numerical scores and it was then transferred directly into SPSS software. Screening of the data set was conducted through an examination of basic descriptive statistics or frequency distributions. Values that were missing, out-of-range or improperly coded were identified with these checks. In this research, a frequency test was run for the eight variables to detect any missing, out-of-range or improperly coded values among the responses. None were found in the data set as all cases for each variable were within the expected range of 1 to 7 (see Appendix 10). 170 4.3.2.2 Composite Variables After entry of the coded data into the SPSS software, the first step was to create composite variables representing each theoretical construct. For each respondent, the average scores across each item of the variable from question 1 to 34 were calculated to form new composite variables representing the respective theoretical constructs as summarised in Table 4.10. Table 4.: Formation of Composite Variables Composite variables Items Market Factors in Domestic Markets mfdm 1-4 Industry Factors in Domestic Markets ifdm 5-8 Market Factors in Foreign Markets mffm 9 - 12 Industry Factors in Foreign Markets iffm 13 - 16 Firm’s Internal Factors finf 17 - 21 Foreign Environmental Factors exef 22 - 26 Support Networks Factors in Foreign Markets snff 27 - 30 IMS Development Decisions Effectiveness imsd 31 - 343313 Theoretical Constructs C Composite variables Questions values Source: Analysis of survey data 4.3.2.3 Factor Analysis After creating the composite variables and having decided that the data were acceptable for further analysis, an exploratory factor analysis was undertaken to assess the latent structure (dimensions) of the screened dataset. 171 Exploratory factor analysis was considered appropriate to assess the factor structures of the data and loadings of items. This procedure seeks to summarise data by grouping together variables that are correlated and provides a tool for consolidating variables about underlying processes (Tabachnick & Fidell 2007). To determine that the data were suitable for factor analysis, the KaiserMeyer-Olkin (KMO) measure of sampling adequacy (MSA) was carried out to pre-analyse the data matrix. This procedure is recommended by Hair et al. (2006) because it quantifies the degree of intercorrelations among the variables and the appropriateness of factor analysis. In addition, Bartlett's test of sphericity, also recommended by Hair et al. (2006) was carried out. This test provides the statistical significance that the correlation matrix has significant correlations among at least some of the variables. KMO measure of sampling adequacy is calculated as a value between 0 and 1, and results close to 1 indicate a high rate of interrelationships between variables. According to Hair et al. (2006), an overall KMO value of above 0.50 is required before proceeding with the factor analysis, while Barlett's test of sphericity seeks a significance level p < 0.05 (Hair et al. 2006). Table 4.11 on the next page summarises the results of each variable, indicating that analysis of the data revealed that all scales met the criteria as described. KMO measure of sampling adequacy ranged from 0.63 to 0.79, while Bartlett's tests of sphericity were all significant, p < 0.05. 172 Table 4.: KMO MSA and Bartlett's Test of Sphericity KMO Measure of Sampling Adequacy Bartlett’s Test of Sphericity Market Factors in Domestic Markets 0.69 <0.05 Industry Factors in Domestic Markets 0.72 <0.05 Market Factors in Foreign Markets 0.78 <0.05 Industry Factors in Foreign Markets 0.76 <0.05 Firm’s Internal Factors 0.68 <0.05 Foreign Environmental Factors 0.71 <0.05 Support Networks Factors in Foreign Markets 0.79 <0.05 IMS Development Decisions Effectiveness 0.63 <0.05 Composite Variables C Source: Analysis of survey data With the acceptance of the above two tests and completion of the preanalysis, the internal consistency (homogeneity) of all the composite variables was checked by performing a factor analysis using principal components extraction method to examine whether all the items in each particular composite variable could be considered to measure a single underlying construct. With the exception of the firm’s internal factors variable, all other composite variables had only one component extracted with an eigenvalue greater than 1.0 and so unidimensionality was assumed for all these composite variables (see Appendix 10). Also, all items in these composite variables displayed component loadings greater than the minimum criterion of 0.50 as specified by Hair et al. (2006) as shown in Table 4.12 on the next page. 173 Table 4.: Factor Analysis Eigenvalues and Component Loadings Item F1 Domestic competition in the local markets 0.83 Shift of customer base in the local markets 0.77 Substitutes of local product / services 0.68 Lack of growth in the local markets 0.70 F2 Local control & restriction in the industry 0.62 Bargaining power of local buyers 0.79 Bargaining power of local suppliers 0.72 Company competitive position in local markets 0.80 F3 Competition in foreign markets 0.72 Existing customers in foreign markets 0.76 Size of customer base in foreign markets 0.85 Substitutes of product / services in foreign markets 0.83 F4 Level of foreign government control 0.76 Foreign market commercial practices 0.76 Barriers of entry in foreign markets 0.69 Local customs and practices in foreign markets 0.81 F5 Company's attitude towards risk 0.92 Meeting overall business objectives 0.78 Existing business capabilities 0.76 Organisational resources commitments 0.65 The company competitive advantages 0.71 F6 Technological differences in foreign markets 0.62 Economic climate in foreign markets 0.71 Cultural practices in foreign markets 0.71 Legal systems in foreign markets 0.68 Political systems in foreign markets 0.81 F7 Government support networks in foreign markets 0.75 Private support networks in foreign markets 0.85 Service providers support in foreign markets 0.84 Agents and distributors support in foreign markets 0.75 F8 IMS decisions contribute to export profits 0.90 IMS decisions achieve export success in foreign markets 0.72 IMS decisions affect export sales 0.90 IMS decisions contribute to export growth 0.58 Eigenvalue 2.23 2.17 2.50 2.28 2.16 2.52 2.57 2.47 Percentage of variance 55.67 54.27 65.51 57.06 43.14 50.40 64.27 61.69 Factor labels: F1 Market Factors in Domestic Markets F5 Firm's Internal Factors F2 Industry Factors in Domestic Markets F6 Foreign Environmental Factors F3 Market Factors in Foreign Markets F7 Support Networks Factors in Foreign Markets F4 Industry Factors in Foreign Markets F8 IMS Development Decisions Effectiveness Source: Analysis of survey data 174 The internal consistency of the composite variable for firm’s internal factors was checked by performing a factor analysis using principal components extraction method to examine whether the five items could be considered to measure a single underlying construct. Two components were extracted with an eigenvalue greater than 1.0 and so unidimensionality was not assumed (see Appendix 10). With this pattern it was decided that items 2 to 5 all seemed to display adequate homogeneity (internal consistency), but this was not the case for item 1. To ensure homogeneity of the composite variable for firm’s internal factors, the first item was removed from the composite variable and another factor analysis was performed. In this case, only one component was extracted with an eigenvalue greater than 1.0 and so unidimensionality was assumed (see Appendix 10). All items displayed component loadings greater than the minimum criterion of 0.50 as specified by Hair et al. (2006). 4.3.2.4 Correlation Analysis To further verify that the items of the dataset are homogenous, an examination of its internal consistency was carried out by examining its correlation using the Pearson Correlation Coefficient test among all key (composite) variables and their associated items (Manning & Munro 2006). It was found that all key variables display correlations with their individual items all greater than 0.5 and inter-item correlations between items are all greater than 0.3, except between item 2 and 3 for market factors in domestic markets variable, item 1, 3 and 4 for industry factors in domestic 175 markets variable, item 1, 3 and 4 for foreign environmental factors variable, and between item 1 and 4 for IMS development decisions effectiveness variable (see Appendix 10). According to Hair et al. (2006), these high correlations indicate similarity of patterns across characteristics between variables. Thus, as advocated by Manning & Munro (2006) and Field (2009), with all key variables displaying correlations with their individual items greater than 0.5 this pattern seems to demonstrate adequate homogeneity of the dataset. 4.3.2.5 Univariate and Multivariate Outliers After checking the composite variables for homogeneity and reliability, the next step in the preliminary analysis of data was to examine the data for outliers. Outliers are unreasonable observations with extreme values on one variable or combination of variables that are distinct from the rest of the data set (Hair et al. 2006; Tabachnick & Fidell 2007). To identify univariate outliers for the variables market factors in domestic markets, industry factors in domestic markets, market factors in foreign markets, industry factors in foreign markets, firm’s internal factors, foreign environmental factors, support networks factors in foreign markets and IMS development decisions effectiveness, boxplots were visually inspected and standard scores were calculated for each respondent. From the boxplots analyses of the above eight key variables, no univariate outliers were found (see Appendix 10). Also, each of these respondents displayed standard scores with an absolute value within +/- 3.29 (p < 0.05). 176 A test for multivariate outliers was then conducted using the techniques described by Tabachnick and Fidell (2007). Using data from the set of eight variables, the Mahalanobis distance was calculated for each case. Tabachnick and Fidell (2007) state that the Mahalanobis distance should be interpreted as a א2 (chi-square) statistic with the degrees of freedom equal to the number of independent variables. The authors recommend that a criterion of p < 0.05 be used to evaluate whether a case is judged to be a multivariate outlier (Tabachnick & Fidell 2007), and so a critical value of א82 = 26.125 was used. No case was identified with a Mahalanobis score in excess of this value and so no multivariate outliers were identified. 4.3.2.6 Normality of Distribution To address the distribution issues of normality in this research, the scores of the variables market factors in domestic markets, industry factors in domestic markets, market factors in foreign markets, industry factors in foreign markets, firm’s internal factors, foreign environmental factors, support networks factors in foreign markets and IMS development decisions effectiveness were investigated. Values of skewness and kurtosis were calculated for the distribution of scores for these variables are shown in Table 4.13 on the next page. To test whether the distribution’s skew significantly deviated from that of a normal distribution, the value for skew was divided by the standard error of the skew to create a z-score. Using the criteria presented by Tabachnick and Fidell (2007), for sample size less than 300, if this value exceeds an absolute value of 2.58, then we say the skew is significant. 177 Table 4.: Skewness and Kurtosis Skewness Composite Variables Kurtosis Statistics Std. Error z-score Statistics Std. Error z-score Market Factors in Domestic Markets -0.18 0.34 -0.54 -0.95 0.67 -1.40 Industry Factors in Domestic Markets -0.22 0.34 -0.64 -0.76 0.67 -1.13 Market Factors in Foreign Markets 0.32 0.34 0.93 -0.10 0.67 -0.15 Industry Factors in Foreign Markets -0.10 0.34 -0.29 -0.92 0.67 -1.36 New Firm’s Internal Factors -0.09 0.34 -0.26 0.02 0.67 0.03 Foreign Environmental Factors -0.15 0.34 -0.43 -0.54 0.67 -0.80 Support Networks Factors 0.20 0.34 0.58 -0.15 0.67 -0.22 IMS Development Decisions Effectiveness 0.01 0.34 0.04 -0.96 0.67 -1.42 Source: Analysis of survey data In this case the sample size was less than 300, the ratio of skew to standard error of skew for all eight variables was less than 2.58 (in absolute terms) and so it was concluded that we did not have significant levels of skew. A similar procedure was conducted for kurtosis where the value for kurtosis was divided by the standard error of kurtosis to create a z-score. Using the criteria presented by Tabachnick and Fidell (2007), for sample size less than 300, if this value exceeds an absolute value of 2.58, then we say the kurtosis is significant. In this case the sample size was less than 300, the ratio of kurtosis to standard error of kurtosis for all eight variables was less than 2.58 (in absolute terms) and so it was concluded that we did not have significant levels of kurtosis. 178 As concluded from the above test for normality of distribution, it appeared that the eight key variables had no significant level of skew or kurtosis from normality. Therefore, there was no need to transform the scores for these distributions. 4.3.2.7 Descriptive Analysis of Data The objective of this descriptive analysis section is to transform the raw data into mean, range, minimum, maximum, standard deviation and variance to display the frequency distributions, measure of central tendency and dispersion of each variable involved (Coakes & Steed 2007). It provides statistical and graphical displays that are useful for describing all the key variables. The results are summarised below in Table 4.14. Table 4.: Descriptive Statistics of Data Composite Variables Mean Range Min Max Std. Dev. Variance Market Factors in Domestic Markets 4.29 2.25 3.25 5.50 0.65 0.42 Industry Factors in Domestic Markets 4.19 2.25 3.25 5.50 0.53 0.33 Market Factors in Foreign Markets 4.10 3.00 2.75 5.75 0.64 0.41 Industry Factors in Foreign Markets 4.13 2.25 3.00 5.25 0.64 0.40 New Firm’s Internal Factors 4.40 2.25 3.25 5.50 0.58 0.34 Foreign Environmental Factors 4.52 2.40 3.00 5.40 0.60 0.36 Support Networks Factors 4.32 3.75 2.50 6.25 0.79 0.63 IMS Development Decisions Effectiveness 4.16 2.25 3.00 5.25 0.66 0.44 Source: Analysis of survey data 179 As there were no extreme values in the data set as indicated in the tests for univariate and multivariate outliers in Section 4.2.3, the mean values above represent the measure of central tendency for the purpose of statistical inference instead of the median or mode. From these statistics, the means for all the variables seem tightly packed, indicating that measures of central tendency for these variables are consistent across the data set (Hair et al. 2006). The range, standard deviation and variance were used to determine the measures of variability of the data. As shown in the Table 4.14 above, most of the standard deviations were less than 1.00, that is, they were small and thus correspond to a small amount of variation in the data set. In contrast to the standard deviation and variance, the range for each variable suggests some variation or dispersion in the process, but the range is based on only the maximum and minimum score, and it is often inferior to other measures of variation like the standard deviations and variance that are based on the value of every score (Sekaran 2003). These descriptive statistics summarise the information contained in the sample of scores of the collected data. The measures of central tendency were consistent and measures of variability were small, exhibiting low dispersion of the data. Hence, the next stage of the data analysis was to classify the data and describe the relationships among these variables. 4.3.3 Common Method Variance A Harman’s one-factor test was carried out to test for the presence of common method variance effect. All the 34 items were entered into an 180 exploratory factor analysis using principal component analysis to determine the number of factors that are necessary to account for the variance in the variables to assess common method variance. According to Podsakoff et al. (2003), if either (a) a single factor emerge from the analysis, or (b) one general factor will account for the majority of the covariance among the variables, substantial amount of common method variance is present. However, the outcome revealed the presence of eight distinct factors with eigenvalue greater than 1.0, rather than a single factor. These eight factors together accounted for 86.24% of the total variance. Thus, no general factor is apparent. The SPSS generated output is shown in the appendix 10. While the results of the principal component analysis do not preclude the possibility of common method variance, it does suggest that common method variance is not of great concern and therefore is unlikely to confound the interpretations of results. 4.3.4 Reliability and Validity To reduce errors and to ensure quality of measurements, all variables in the questionnaire were tested for reliability and validity as stated in Section 3.3.2.3. The reliability issue was addressed by calculating the coefficients of reliability or Cronbach’s alpha values of all eight composite variables. Validity was addressed by initiating Davis’s (2005) four-step procedure to measure the content (face) validity of the questionnaire. 181 4.3.4.1 Reliability The reliability of data was confirmed by calculating the coefficient (Cronbach’s) alpha value of each composite variable. The value indicates a level of confidence in the reliability of the questionnaire in terms of measuring the underlying dimension (Hair et al. 2006). The alpha value ranges from 0 (perfectly unreliable) to 1 (perfectly reliable). Any construct that scores a value higher than 0.80 is considered significantly reliable; and any alpha scores between 0.70 to 0.80 is assumed to be acceptable (Hair et al. 2006). Cronbach’s alpha for all composite variables are presented in Table 4.15. Table 4.: Cronbach’s alpha Value of Composite Variables C Composite Variables Items Cronbach alpha values Market Factors in Domestic Markets 1-4 0.73 Industry Factors in Domestic Markets 5-8 0.72 Market Factors in Foreign Markets 9 - 12 0.80 Industry Factors in Foreign Markets 13 - 16 0.75 New Firm’s Internal Factors 18 - 21 0.71 Foreign Environmental Factors 22 - 26 0.75 Support Networks Factors 27 - 30 0.81 IMS Development Decisions Effectiveness 31 - 343313 0.79 Composite variables Questions values Source: Analysis of survey data The results indicate that Cronbach’s alpha for the composite variables market factors in foreign markets was 0.80 and support networks factors in 182 foreign markets was just above 0.80 (α = 0.81) which could be considered to represent highly acceptable reliability (Hair et al. 2006). The other remaining variables: market factors in domestic markets, industry factors in domestic markets, industry factors in foreign markets, firm’s internal factors, foreign environmental factors and IMS development decisions effectiveness were above 0.70 (α ranging from 0.71 to 0.79) which could be considered to represent acceptable reliability (Hair et al. 2006). 4.3.4.2 Validity Davis (2005) proposed a four-step procedure to address the content (face) validity of survey research. Firstly, conduct an exhaustive search of the literature for all possible items to be included in the scale. Secondly, solicit expert opinions on the inclusion of items. Thirdly, pre-test the scale on a set of respondents similar to the population to be studied. Finally, modify as necessary with the feedback and reflect it in the final draft. All these four steps were followed in this research to ensure content (face) validity. The literature review presented in Chapter Two was employed intensively to formulate the questionnaire. The draft questionnaire was circulated among three academic experts in the field for their feedback, and pre-tested by four respondents who were similar to those in the target population in terms of background characteristics and familiarity with the topic. A pilot study was also carried out. Finally, the feedback was incorporated into the completion of the final draft of the questionnaire. 183 4.3.5 Testing of Research Hypotheses As stated in Chapter Three, there were four hypotheses with the first hypothesis separated into four sub-hypotheses, developed in Chapter Two to be tested as follows: Hypothesis 1: The consideration of market and industry factors in both domestic and foreign markets are positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 1a: The consideration of market factors in domestic markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 1b: The consideration of industry factors in domestic markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 1c: The consideration of market factors in foreign markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 1d: The consideration of industry factors in foreign markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. 184 Hypothesis 2: The consideration of the firm's internal factors is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 3: The consideration of foreign environmental factors is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 4: The consideration of public and private support networks in foreign markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. As the survey’s data satisfied the assumption of normality and both dependent and independent variables were measured in interval scales, as advocated by Manning & Munro (2006) and Hair et al. (2006), a standard multiple linear regression was performed between IMS development decisions effectiveness as the dependent variable and market factors in domestic markets, industry factors in domestic markets, market factors in foreign markets, industry factors in foreign markets, new firm’s internal factors, foreign environmental factors and support networks factors in foreign markets as independent variables to determine any relationships. The use of the standard multiple linear regression test determines the strength of the relationship between each of the seven independent variables individually, and the dependent variable. (Hair et al. 2006; Manning & Munro 2006; Tabachnick & Fidell 2007). 185 The multiple correlation coefficient (R = 0.90) was significant which means that the combined correlation of the seven independent variables with the dependent variable is high (Hair et al. 2006; Manning & Munro 2006). The F statistic with degree of freedom of 7 and 40 (F (7,40) = 24.88, p < 0.05) means that the seven independent variables, as a set, are significantly related to the dependent variable. Thus the multiple correlation coefficient is significant (Hair et al. 2006; Manning & Munro 2006). Furthermore, 81.3% of the variation in the dependent variable was explained by the set of independent variables (R2 = 0.81) (see Appendix 10). Accordingly, this means that market factors in domestic markets, industry factors in domestic markets, market factors in foreign markets, industry factors in foreign markets, new firm’s internal factors, foreign environmental factors and support networks factors in foreign markets accounts for 81.3% of the variation in the effectiveness of the development decisions of IMS (Hair et al. 2006; Manning & Munro 2006). Yet, individual predictors such as industry factors in foreign markets, sri2 = 0.0086, b = 0.24, t = 1.36, p > 0.05, market factors in foreign markets, sri2 = 0.0074, b = 0.20, t = 1.27, p > 0.05, foreign environmental factors, sri2 = 0.0053, b = 0.31, t = 1.07, p > 0.05, new firm’s internal factors, sri2 = 0.0013, b = 0.09, t = 0.53, p > 0.05; industry factors in domestic markets, sri2 = 0.0012, b = 0.09, t = 0.51, p > 0.05 and market factors in domestic markets, sri2 = 0.0008, b = 0.09, t = 0.41, p > 0.05 are all non-significant. As the above b-values are positive in nature, it indicates that there are positive relationships between the predictors and the outcome (Field 2009). Since t-values are derived from the b-values divided by its standard error 186 (Manning & Munro 2006), any polarity changes in b-values will also affect the t-values in similar way. However, all the b-values and t-values are statistically non-significant. Therefore, market factors in domestic markets, industry factors in domestic markets, market factors in foreign markets, industry factors in foreign markets, new firm’s internal factors and foreign environmental factors cannot contribute to the expectation of a positive relationship with IMS development decisions effectiveness. Conversely, support networks factors in foreign markets was found to have a negative b-value indicating a negative relationship between the predictor and the outcome (Field 2009). Since both b-value and t-value are statistically non-significant, it would appear that support networks factors in foreign markets cannot provide any contribution to the expectation of a negative relationship with IMS development decisions effectiveness (b = 0.08, t = - 1.29, p > 0.05). As can be seen from the above multiple linear regression analysis, there is a lack of statistical significance findings on the t-values in the relationship between all of the independent variables and the dependent variable. Perhaps this can be attributed to the limited number of responses and the cross-sectional nature of the sample with respondents coming from a variety of different industries which could influence the multicollinearity (Hair et al. 2006; Tabachnick & Fidell 2007). A summary of the multiple linear regression analysis findings is shown in Table 4.16 on the next page. 187 Table 4.: Multiple Linear Regression Findings Multiple R R2 Results 0.90 0.81 Significant b-values t-values Results Market Factors in Domestic Markets 0.09 0.41 Non-significant Industry Factors in Domestic Markets Market Factors in Foreign Markets Industry Factors in Foreign Markets Firm’s Internal Factors (new) Foreign Environmental Factors Support Networks Factors in Foreign Markets 0.09 0.51 0.20 0.24 0.09 0.31 1.27 1.36 0.53 1.07 Non-significant Non-significant Non-significant Non-significant Non-significant -0.08 -1.29 Non-significant Dependent Variable IMS Development Decisions Effectiveness Independent Variables Source: Analysis of survey data From the statistical data analysis performed, it can be concluded that the combined market factors in domestic markets, industry factors in domestic markets, market factors in foreign markets, industry factors in foreign markets, new firm’s internal factors, foreign environmental factors and support networks factors in foreign markets contributed significantly to the IMS development decisions effectiveness. Though there are signs of positive relationships between each of the predicators with the outcome, except support networks factors in foreign markets which indicates a negative relationship, the results of these individual predictors are statistically non-significant. Therefore, it cannot lay claim to the support of the four research hypotheses, specifically Hypothesis 1 where market and industry factors in domestic and foreign markets are positively related to the effectiveness of the 188 development decisions a firm’s international marketing strategy, Hypothesis 2 where the firm's internal factors are positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions a firm’s international marketing strategy, Hypothesis 3 where foreign environmental factors are positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions a firm’s international marketing strategy, and Hypothesis 4 where public and private support networks in foreign markets are positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions a firm’s international marketing strategy. 4.3.6 Non-Parametric Analysis Due to the smaller sample size of the data available for analysis, a nonparametric technique using the Spearman rank correlation coefficient (Spearman's rho) test was used to verify the significance of relationship between the variables. It was found that there were significant positive correlation between the dependent variable IMS development decisions effectiveness and independent variables market factors in domestic markets (rs = 0.83, p < 0.05), industry factors in domestic markets (rs = 0.78, p < 0.05), market factors in foreign markets (rs = 0.86, p < 0.05), industry factors in foreign markets (rs = 0.83, p < 0.05), new firm’s internal factors (rs = 0.77, p < 0.05), foreign environmental factors (rs = 0.87, p < 0.05) and non-significant negative correlation between the dependent variable IMS development decisions effectiveness and independent variable support networks factors in foreign markets, rs = - 0.07, p > 0.05 (see Appendix 10). 189 The correlation between independent and dependent variables is shown in Table 4.17. Table 4.: Correlation between independent and dependent variables Market Factors in Domestic Market Industry Factors in Domestic Market Market Factors in Foreign Market Industry Factors in Foreign Market Foreign Environmental Factors Support Network Factors in Foreign Markets New Firm's Internal Factors IMS Development Decisions Effectiveness Market Factors in Domestic Market 1 0.89 0.86 0.80 0.92 0.07 0.90 0.83 Industry Factors in Domestic Market 0.89 1 0.83 0.76 0.88 0.10 0.88 0.78 Market Factors in Foreign Market 0.86 0.83 1 0.80 0.89 -0.07 0.82 0.86 Industry Factors in Foreign Market 0.80 0.76 0.80 1 0.91 0.01 0.71 0.83 0.92 0.88 0.89 0.91 1 0.03 0.85 0.87 Support Network Factors in Foreign Markets 0.07 0.10 -0.07 0.01 0.03 1 0.01 -0.07 New Firm's Internal Factors 0.90 0.84 0.82 0.71 0.85 0.01 1 0.77 IMS Development Decisions Effectiveness 0.83 0.78 0.86 0.83 0.87 -0.07 0.77 1 Foreign Environmental Factors Source: Analysis of survey data This indicates that the strength of the linear relationship between the independent variables market factors in domestic markets, industry factors in domestic markets, market factors in foreign markets, industry factors in foreign markets, new firm’s internal factors, foreign environmental factors and the dependent variable IMS development decisions effectiveness are strong, whereas the strength of the linear relationship between the independent variable support networks factors in foreign markets with other variables is very weak. 190 4.4 Summary of Research Findings Findings from the qualitative data gathered during the exploratory research phase were incorporated into the final survey instrument to test the hypotheses using quantitative methods in the descriptive and causal research phase. Research findings from the quantitative data collected from the online web-based survey carried out during the descriptive and causal research phase are presented in the following tables. The results of the demographic data of respondents are summarised in Table 4.18. Table 4.: Demographics of Respondents Characteristics of respondents Percentage of the largest category Industry category 37.50% are in the high technology sector Ownership type 62.50% are Australian owned proprietary company Length of international experience 83.30% have more than 5 years Product/services marketed overseas 70.80% are in more than 10 countries Annual international turnover 66.70% are between A$5.0 to A$50.0 million Market entry mode 100% are exporters Source: Analysis of survey data The results of the hypotheses testing are summarised in Table 4.19 on the next page. 191 Table 4.: Summary of Hypotheses Testing Research Hypotheses Hypothesis 1a: The consideration of market factors in domestic markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 1b: The consideration of industry factors in domestic markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 1c: The consideration of market factors in foreign markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Results Not Supported Not Supported Not Supported Hypothesis 1d: The consideration of industry factors in foreign markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Not Supported Hypothesis 2: The consideration of the firm's internal factors is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Not Supported Hypothesis 3: The consideration of foreign environmental factors is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Not Supported Hypothesis 4: The consideration of public and private support networks in foreign markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Not Supported Source: Analysis of survey data 4.5 Conclusion This chapter analyses the data collected from respondents who have participated in the in-depth interviews and online web-based survey. Findings from the qualitative data gathered from the in-depth interviews during the exploratory research phase were incorporated into the final survey questionnaire to test the hypotheses using quantitative methods in the descriptive and causal research phase. 192 Of 204 questionnaires emailed to the international marketing / export departments of these firms, 54 were returned with six responses not fully completed, thus providing 48 usable valid responses for further analysis. The results were classified into three categories: preliminary analysis of data, classification of data and the statistical testing of hypotheses. In the preliminary analysis of data, the raw data was screened and the internal consistency for composite variables was checked. Univariate and multivariate outliers were also examined. Tests of normality of distribution were carried out and no significant skew and kurtosis in the distribution were detected, and therefore the distribution was close to normal. Furthermore, descriptive analysis of data to measure the central tendency and dispersion, and display the frequency distribution also confirmed that the data set was close to a normal distribution. Test for the presence of common method variance effect were carried out using Harman’s one-factor test resulting in non-substantial amount of common method variance detected. For the reliability of data, Cronbach’s alpha value of each composite variable was calculated. These tests indicated that all eight composite variables were reliable. Validity of data was ensured by performing Davis (2005) four-step procedure to address the content (face) validity issue. In the testing of hypotheses concerning relationships between market factors in domestic markets, industry factors in domestic markets, market factors in foreign markets, industry factors in foreign markets, new firm’s internal factors, foreign environmental factors, support networks factors in foreign markets and IMS development decisions effectiveness; standard 193 multiple linear regression analysis was used. The findings showed that the all four hypotheses were not supported by the survey data due to a lack of statistically significant results. Finally, a non-parametric analysis using Spearman rank correlation coefficient test was performed and had shown that there were significant positive correlation between the dependent variable and most independent variables, except for the support networks factors in foreign markets independent variable where a non-significant negative correlation was found. The next chapter will summarise this study, its contribution to knowledge, its implications for theory, policy and practice as well as its limitations and provide recommendations for future research. 194 CHAPTER FIVE Conclusions and Implications Chapter 1 Introduction Chapter 2 Literature Review Chapter 3 Research Design and Methodology Chapter 4 Data Analysis and Research Findings 5.1 Introduction Chapter 5 Conclusions and Implications 5.2 Discussion of Hypotheses 5.3 Conclusions from Research Findings 5.4 Contribution of this Research 5.5 Limitations of this Research 5.6 Future Research 5.7 Conclusion 195 5 CONCLUSIONS AND IMPLICATIONS 5.1 Introduction In the previous chapter, the research findings were presented, with a detailed description of the data analysis procedures, together with a description of the statistical tests performed on the collected data. The chapter begins with a discussion of the research findings for each hypothesis in relation to the literature review (Section 5.2). Research findings to address the research question and its conclusions are examined (Section 5.3). Next, the study’s contribution to knowledge, and its implications for theory, policy and practice study are covered (Section 5.4) and are followed by a discussion on the limitations of this research (Section 5.5). Recommendations for future research are presented (Section 5.6) and the study is summarised in the final conclusion (Section 5.7). 5.2 Discussion of Hypotheses Underpinning the Research Questions Although the importance of international marketing strategy developmental decisions were argued in academic literature and international marketing texts, the current international market development process models promulgated in international marketing texts reflect neither the breadth of theory underpinning the factors influencing the development of international marketing strategy, nor approaches adopted by successful Australian exporters. 196 The literature review has identified key aspects of current international marketing strategy development processes. Following this theoretical guidance and with an integrated qualitative and quantitative mixed methods research methodology that brings together theories underpinning international market strategy development with successful business practice; and in pursuit of identifying the factors that successful Australian exporters consider in developing their international marketing strategy, four hypotheses were developed and tested. The four hypotheses with the first hypothesis separated into four sub-hypotheses that were tested using quantitative methods are as follows: Hypothesis 1: The consideration of market and industry factors in both domestic and foreign markets are positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 1a: The consideration of market factors in domestic markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 1b: The consideration of industry factors in domestic markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions marketing strategy. 197 of a firm’s international Hypothesis 1c: The consideration of market factors in foreign markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 1d: The consideration of industry factors in foreign markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 2: The consideration of the firm's internal factors is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 3: The consideration of foreign environmental factors is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 4: The consideration of public and private support networks in foreign markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. These hypotheses were developed from the literature review and reflected the international marketing strategy development behaviour of the firms that participated in the qualitative research. They were then subjected to quantitative analysis to assess whether they were generalisable to the population of specific interest to this research, that is, successful exporters in 198 Australia. The findings of the mixed methods research were reported in Chapter Four. In the following section, research findings relating to each of the above empirically tested hypotheses are discussed with conclusions drawn. 5.2.1 Review and Conclusion for Hypothesis One The first hypothesis developed from the literature review is: Hypothesis 1: The consideration of market and industry factors in both domestic and foreign markets are positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. This is separated into four sub-hypotheses, each of which represents a market or industry factor in both domestic and foreign markets studied in this research, and are tested separately as follows: Hypothesis 1a: The consideration of market factors in domestic markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 1b: The consideration of industry factors in domestic markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Hypothesis 1c: The consideration of market factors in foreign markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. 199 Hypothesis 1d: The consideration of industry factors in foreign markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. Review of the market and industry factors in both the domestic and foreign markets are discussed below. Conversely, as reported by the research findings in Chapter Four, the four sub-hypotheses of the first hypothesis were not empirically supported by the survey’s quantitative data analysis due to the lack of statistically significant results on the individual predicator. This implies that market and industry factors in both domestic and foreign markets do not have a positive relationship with the effectiveness of the development decisions of international marketing strategy among successful Australian exporters. 5.2.1.1 Market and Industry Factors in Domestic Markets The findings of this study provide some insight into the major factors that have influenced the development of international marketing strategy practices of exporting businesses in Australia. The qualitative study found that market and industry factors in the domestic markets are considered to be minor factors in the development of international marketing strategies among successful Australian exporters. However, this was not empirically supported by the quantitative data due to a lack of statistically significant results. Such market and industry factors in the domestic markets include (1) size of the customer base, (2) competition, (3) the power of substitutes for the firm’s products/services, (4) growth potential, (5) controls and restrictions on 200 the industry, (6) bargaining power of buyers and suppliers, and (7) firm's competitive position. These factors were raised in the in-depth interviews of the qualitative study by all the interviewees, thus validating that market and industry factors in the domestic markets were considered in the development of their firm’s international marketing strategies. However, due to a lack of statistically significant results from the survey’s quantitative data analysis, the hypothesis that there is a positive relationship between market and industry factors in domestic markets, and the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy cannot be empirically supported, even though indication of a positive relationship exists. According to the literature review, all the above factors have, to some extent, affected the decision of businesses to start their export endeavour (Doole & Lowe 2008). With a shrinking customer base and rising competitiveness in the local market, the only avenue for growth for many businesses is to export into international markets. Similarly, more substitutes for the firm’s products/services, slowing growth potential, tougher controls and restrictions on the industry, rising bargaining power of buyers and suppliers, and declining firm's competitive position in the local market can also affect many firms’ decision to look towards international markets (Doole & Lowe 2008). Thus, with regards to the market and industry factors in the domestic markets, the qualitative results support the argument by Doole and Lowe 201 (2008) that these factors do influence the development of international marketing strategy and contribute to more exports. However from the qualitative study, it seems that successful Australian exporters do consider market and industry factors in domestic markets when developing their international marketing strategy, but do not place great importance on these factors; deeming them as minor factors in their international marketing strategy development. Perhaps, this is because the domestic market in Australia is still lucrative and growing. 5.2.1.2 Market and Industry Factors in Foreign Markets The qualitative study found that market and industry factors in foreign markets are factors in the development of international marketing strategies among successful Australian exporters. Such market and industry factors in foreign markets include (1) size of the customer base, (2) competition, (3) the power of substitutes for the firm’s products/services, (4) growth potential, (5) controls and restrictions on the industry, (6) bargaining power of buyers and suppliers, (7) firm's competitive position, (8) overseas distribution networks, (9) level of foreign government control on the industry, (10) overseas markets’ commercial practices, (11) threat of new entrants to the industry, and (12) foreign markets’ customs and practices of the industry. All the above factors were validated in the qualitative study as most interviewees mentioned that they had considered the above market and industry factors in the foreign markets when developing their international marketing strategies, except for one ICT e-commerce company that did not 202 need to consider the market and industry factors in the foreign markets. This is perhaps because their business model is virtual in nature, which hardly has any effects on the competition, customer base, product/services substitution, distribution networks and local/ commercial practices in the foreign markets. However, due to a lack of statistically significant results from the survey’s quantitative data analysis, the hypothesis that there is a positive relationship between market and industry factors in foreign markets, and the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy cannot be empirically supported, even though there is indication of a positive relationship. It has been established through the qualitative study among successful exporters, that when deciding to export to any particular international market, market attractiveness is one of the primary market factors considered in the development of their international marketing strategy. This finding supports the study of Rahman’s (2001:2006) key factors on international market selection considered by successful Australian international firms. Market attractiveness is affected by market factors, such as size of the customer base; growth potential in the markets and customer bargaining power; and by competitive factors, such as the structure of competition and substitutes. Competitiveness for the firm means its ability to increase earnings by expanding sales and/or profit margins in the markets in which it competes, that is, the firm’s competitive position. This competitive position is influenced by its market position – share, differentiation, product range and image; by its economic and technological position – cost structure, capacity, patents; and capability: – management and marketing strengths, channel power and its 203 relationships with labour and government. The extent to which a firm proves successful in defending its position will clearly be dependent upon its ability and the strategy it chooses to follow. Competition on the other hand means the firm’s ability to defend its market position as the rivalry in products and production processes evolve. Competition in home markets is often the catalyst for expanding into overseas markets. Furthermore, the analysis of competition in target markets is always carried out when developing an international marketing strategy, as its success is dependent upon the strength of the competitive analysis on which it is based. Thus, competition among marketers in the foreign markets is well considered in the development of an international marketing strategy as it is another primary factor influencing the success of their strategy. Another market factor that has an impact on the development of an international marketing strategy is the distribution networks in the foreign markets. Particularly for MNCs, the supply chain internationalisation of outsourcing its supplies is an increasingly important consideration in their strategic decisions. Thus, the distribution networks in target markets are important factors for these organisations when developing their international marketing strategy. At the same time, SMEs are also benefiting from these strategic moves by piggybacking on the MNC’s international development and expansion. This distribution networks in overseas markets supports Ling-Yee and Ogunmokun’s (2001) research that supply chain or channel support do influence the development of international marketing strategy and were found 204 to significantly and positively correlate with export performance of the enterprise. In addition to the above market factors, industry factors in foreign markets such as the level of foreign government control, and restrictions on the industry, have an impact on the development of international marketing strategies. These governmental controls can include measures such as tariffs and non-tariff barriers like quotas. Tariffs have strategic implications for exporters as it places them at a competitive disadvantage to locally competing firms. Although tariffs have generally declined over recent years, they still influence the price competitiveness in international markets and, as such, are considered in the development of an international marketing strategy. These findings in the qualitative study are in line with Doole and Lowe (2003) and Jeannet and Hennessey (2004) argument that the presence of barriers such as tariffs and quotas affect an organisation’s international marketing strategy development process. Likewise, the threat of new entrants to the industry, foreign markets’ customs and commercial practices of the industry have a similar effect on the development of an international marketing strategy. New entrants to the industry mean more competition for the firm; and to be successful in overseas markets, the local customs and commercial practices of the industry must not be neglected. 205 5.2.2 Review and Conclusion for Hypothesis Two The second hypothesis developed from the literature review is: Hypothesis 2: The consideration of the firm's internal factors is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. In this study, the firm’s internal factors refer to (1) the firm's attitude towards risk, (2) the overall business objectives, and (3) the necessary business capabilities, resources and competitive advantages of the firm. One of the strategic guidelines that successful Australian exporters use in their international marketing strategy development is their risk acceptance guideline. Like individuals, firms may be risk-averse, risk-neutral or risk seeking (Hubbard 2004). Certain international markets may seem attractive in absolute terms, but may not be selected if the firm finds the market too risky in relation to its defined risk acceptance guideline. This confirms that an organisational attitude towards risk also plays an important part in the development of international marketing strategy (Tse et al. 1988). Business objectives of the organisation involve assessing the statements of the organisation such as its vision and/or mission to understand what it is trying to do, and to comprehend its organisational values. Often, the decision to market their products / services overseas is reflected in the business objectives of the organisation. This supports the view of Knight (2000) that objectives of the organisation have a large influence in the development of an organisation’s international marketing strategy. The success of an international marketing strategy is influenced by the existence of complementary markets and marketing skills that can increase 206 the total market return on investment. This influence normally occurs where the firm has some skills or expertise that will allow quick access to the market or where the target market is compatible with existing markets of the firm. To compete successfully in today's international markets, firms and their managers must master certain skills and competencies. Such competencies include: (1) strategic competence, that is, the ability to focus on strategic or long-term requirements of their firms; and (2) functional competence, or marketing and managerial competence, that is, being able to design and implement market strategies and organise them effectively. Firms vary widely in these areas of competencies, and different overseas markets require different levels of competencies for the firms to be successful. As a result, a match between the target market requirements and the firm's capabilities is vital when developing an international marketing strategy. As such, firmspecific characteristics and export marketing strategy significantly influence the international marketing performance of these businesses (Lu & Julian 2008). Another question is whether the pursuit of a particular strategy is compatible with firm's competitive advantages. When a firm succeeds in creating greater value for customers than do its competitors, that firm is said to enjoy competitive advantage. Thus, competitive advantage is measured in relation to rivals in a given industry. Value, competitive advantage, and the focus required to achieve them, are universal in their relevance and should guide marketing efforts in international markets. Findings from the qualitative study among the five companies are very similar. All the companies have taken into consideration their business 207 objectives, competitive advantages, attitude towards risk, business’s resources and core capabilities, and top management aspirations and commitment when developing their international marketing strategies, with only one company not taking into consideration their firm’s attitude towards risk. Thus, it validate that the firm’s internal factors were considered when developing their international marketing strategies. Thus, with regards to the firm’s internal factors, the qualitative study support the argument by Cavusgil and Zou (1994) that international marketing strategy is influenced by both internal and external factors and are the key determinants of export marketing performance. However, due to a lack of statistically significant results from the survey’s quantitative data analysis, the hypothesis that there is a positive relationship between the firm’s internal factors and the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy cannot be empirically supported, even though indication of a positive relationship exists. This conclusion therefore implies that the firm’s internal factors do not influence the development of international marketing strategy among successful Australian exporters. 5.2.3 Review and Conclusion for Hypothesis Three The third hypothesis developed from the literature review is: Hypothesis 3: The consideration of foreign environmental factors is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. 208 External macro-environmental issues include those general influences that affect many industries. These issues are beyond the control of the organisation. However, they have some of the most profound influences on an organisation’s international marketing strategy development. In this study, the external environmental factors are: (1) economic, (2) political, (3) legal, (4) technological, and (5) social / cultural. Economic indicators could include GNP, personal disposable income growth rates, inflation rates, unemployment levels, interest rates, exchange rates, taxation rates and wage rates. As there are more than 200 countries in the world, there are varying GNP per capita, economic conditions and levels of economic development. Thus, it is important that exporters have an understanding of economic developments in their target markets and how they impinge on their international marketing strategy. Changes in economic policies in the targeted countries can in many ways have an effect on the adoption of international marketing strategy. The political environment is intrinsically linked to government’s attitude to business and freedom within which it allows firms to operate. This often means that the political arena is the most volatile area of international marketing as the tendencies of governments to change regulations can seriously affect the development of an international marketing strategy, providing it with both opportunities and threats. As stated by Jain (2004), the invisible hand and the heavy interventionist role of government do have an impact on the development of international marketing strategy. Apart from specific legislation which comes from political influences, developments in the legal system can also have an important influence on the 209 development of an international marketing strategy (Bradley 2005). Therefore, it is important for the firm to know the legal environment in each of its markets, as it will impact upon the organisation’s ability to market into particular overseas countries. These laws in the target markets constitute the rules of the game for their business activities and will affect the marketing mix in terms of products, price, distribution and promotional activities quite dramatically. At the same time, the ability to envisage and handle legal problems in foreign countries was a major attribute in high performing Australian exporters as according to Ogunmokun and Ng (2004). Technology is a major driving force both in international marketing and in the move towards a more global marketplace. The impact of technological advances can be seen in all aspects of the marketing process. Particularly, marketers must be able to recognise the limits of their technology, know what new technologies are emerging, and decide when to incorporate new technology in their products and services when developing their international marketing strategy (Jain 2004). As such, exporters need to consider the technological environment in their target markets when developing their international marketing strategy. Social and cultural trends are often difficult to capture in strategic analysis, because they change almost imperceptibly. However, their influences on the development of international marketing strategy are immense. Cultural influences have been identified as significant determinants of international marketing behaviour and export performance as according to Faaborg et al. (2005), Rugimbana and Nwankwo (2003) and Thirkell and Ramadhani (1998). 210 Differences in social conditions, religion and culture, all affect consumers’ perceptions and buying behaviour. It is in this area that determines the extent to which consumers across the globe are classified as either similar or different and so advocates the marketing concept of standardisation and adaptation. It is interesting to note that the firm’s internal factors discussed in the previous sub-section, and external environmental factors discussed here, are both evaluated in the strategy development process at all three levels of the organisation’s strategies, that is, its functional, business and corporate strategy. Perhaps this is so because according to the literature, strategy development in organisations, irrespective of the strategy hierarchy, takes into consideration both internal and external factors (Hubbard 2004, Cavusgil & Zou 1994). Findings from the qualitative study indicate that economic, political, legal, technological, and social / cultural factors have been taken into consideration when developing their firm’s international marketing strategies. However, an observation was made that in the ICT industries, where the business model of e-commerce companies is virtual and operations are rooted solely on the Internet World Wide Web, environmental factors in the foreign markets are not taken into consideration when firms are developing their international marketing strategy as they do not need strategies to target specific markets due to the fact that the Internet is global in nature. Although many studies have examined strategy development and many models promulgated with a conclusive decision to consider both the firm’s internal and external environmental factors when developing a strategy 211 at functional, business and corporate levels, it may be wise for exporters to consider the specific market and industry factors in both domestic and foreign markets that were identified in this study when developing their international marketing strategy. As reported by the research findings in Chapter Four, this third hypothesis was not empirically supported by the quantitative data of the survey due to a lack of statistically significant results, even though there is indication of a positive relationship. This implies that environmental factors do not influence the development of international marketing strategy among successful Australian exporters. 5.2.4 Review and Conclusion for Hypothesis Four The fourth hypothesis developed from the literature review is: Hypothesis 4: The consideration of public and private support networks in foreign markets is positively related to the effectiveness of the development decisions of a firm’s international marketing strategy. In this study, public support networks are the Australian government agencies, at both federal and state / territory levels that provide international marketing advice and intelligence for Australian exporters. These government agencies include Austrade and the various states / territories trade and investment offices in overseas countries. On the contrary, private support networks refer to personal contacts with family, friends, other business associates with whom they have personal relationships, especially for SMEs, and also includes distribution channels partners like agents and/or 212 distributors, chambers of commerce and business support agencies with whom they have commercial relationships in the foreign countries. The Australian government recognises the benefits of exports in terms of the contribution they make to jobs and wealth creation for the country, and offers support to Australian international marketers for their development in general, and the encouragement of exporting in particular. Other public and private organisations also provide the exporters with a range of services to support their international marketing activity. According to the literature review, these public and private support networks are factors to be considered when developing an international marketing strategy, particularly for SMEs (Doole & Lowe 2008). On the contrary, the findings of the qualitative research found that public support networks and particularly private support networks were rarely considered among the five companies interviewed when developing their firm’s international marketing strategies. Likewise, the findings of the quantitative study as reported in Chapter Four established that the fourth hypothesis was not empirically supported. Furthermore, there is indication of a negative relationship, though the results are statistically non-significant. Therefore, the conclusion implies that public and private support networks in foreign markets do not influence the development of international marketing strategy among successful Australian exporters. It may be argued that the majority of successful exporters who participated in this research are mostly experienced international marketers with more than five years of international business experience, have marketed 213 their products / services overseas in more than ten countries and with an international turnover of more than AUD5.0 million (see Section 4.6.2 Table 4.36). These established players generally have their own support resources and thus do not give too much consideration to the issues of public and private support networks as key factors in the development of their international marketing strategy. However, if this research was conducted among new international marketers with little international business experience, this particular finding could have been different. 5.3 Conclusions from the Research Findings Regarding the Research Questions If considered against the first research question addressed by this study as raised in Chapter One: What are the key factors influencing the development of international marketing strategies among successful Australian exporters? The findings of this study lead to the following conclusions: (1) Market and industry factors in the domestic and foreign markets are primary factors that influence the development of international marketing strategy among successful exporters. (2) Firm’s internal factors are also primary factors that influence the development of international marketing strategy among successful exporters. 214 (3) External environmental factors in the foreign markets are primary factors and have a strong influence in the development of international marketing strategy among successful exporters. (4) The public and private support networks in the foreign markets are extraneous factors and do not influence the development of international marketing strategy among successful exporters. If considered against the second research question addressed by this study as raised in Chapter One: Are the key factors influencing the development of international marketing strategies among successful Australian exporters related to the effectiveness of the strategy development decisions? The findings of this study lead to the following conclusions: (1) Australian successful exporters follow a variety of multi-dimensional strategy development processes, and consider a wide range of internal and external factors in both the domestic and foreign markets when developing their international marketing strategies. (2) It is the integration of these considered factors, especially all the primary factors as a whole within the strategy development process that determine the decisions on the choice and direction of the organisation’s international marketing strategy, and therefore the above key factors are directly related to the effectiveness of the strategy development decisions. 215 These findings are consistent with recommendations and findings of strategic management theories, decision making theories, international marketing theories, marketing strategy theories and international marketing strategy theories as discussed in the literature review in Chapter Two of this thesis, except for item 4 relating to the first research question, the networks support factor in foreign markets. Perhaps this is because the research was conducted among successful exporters who are either finalists or winners of the Australian export awards, and are therefore accomplished and established players in international markets. This might not be the case if the research was conducted among new and lesser experienced exporters. Then the public and private support networks in the foreign markets could be a factor to be considered in the development of their international marketing strategy. 5.4 Contributions of This Research The development of an international marketing strategy is an important aspect of international marketing. Every time a business decides to market its products and/or services overseas, it must develop an appropriate international marketing strategy. This development process is based on managerial decisions with due considerations to the many factors, both internally and externally that affect this process. Accordingly, it is vital that international marketers should have some pre-set decision variables to guide their development of an international marketing strategy, as well as understand the factors that influence the 216 development process of their strategy. This research has identified these factors and also confirms that all these factors contribute significantly to the development of an international marketing strategy, and may be followed by other aspiring businesses. International marketing academics have identified the importance of an international marketing strategy and have presented a range of decision variables and various models to guide the development process. However, most of these models are mere propositions and have not been empirically tested in order for these theories to be integrated into the general body of international marketing strategy theory. Furthermore, there has been minimal reported research studying the factors influencing the development of international marketing strategy on exporters carried out in Australia. By empirical testing of the variables affecting the development process of international marketing strategies among successfully exporters in Australia, this research fills that gap. This work represents one of the few empirical studies on the development process of international marketing strategy. Accordingly, in the following section the contribution of this research will be analysed from academic and practitioner perspectives. 5.4.1 Implications for Theory In one sense there is nothing new in the findings of this research; many of the factors or variables described have been previously established in other areas of international marketing, marketing strategy and strategic marketing. However, the implications of such findings on the development of international 217 marketing strategies among successful exporters in Australia have been overlooked by researchers. This empirical study fills that gap. This research successfully integrates and applies existing knowledge in decision-making theories, strategic management theories, marketing strategy theories, marketing theories, international marketing theories, and trade theories to this research and empirically tests the research hypotheses. It identifies and establishes the factors related to the development process of international marketing strategies among Australian exporters. These factors play a significant role in the decisions on the choice and direction of an organisation’s international marketing strategy. These key factors must be taken into consideration by any business when developing their international marketing strategy if they hope to achieve sustainable progress in their international marketing operations. This research has identified and tested specific hypotheses, and has developed measurement scales for those hypotheses. These hypotheses and their measurement scales can now form the basis for further research in this area both in Australia and overseas. Compared to internationalisation process theories, the development process of an international marketing strategy is not a well-researched area. There has been minimal reported study in Australia and such research has not been widely reported overseas. This research is a major study on an important, but overlooked, area of business importance. Another major contribution of this research is the successful integration of both qualitative and quantitative approaches in this study. The use of mixed methods research methodology reflects an attempt to secure an in-depth 218 understanding of the phenomenon in question which provide a greater diversity of views and stronger inferences on the research accuracy, and offer a fuller and more comprehensive study. 5.4.2 Implications for Policy and Practice The development of an international marketing strategy plays a major function in the overall process of moving into international markets. Many international marketers take a leading role in the development process of their international marketing strategy. Others acquire expert help from consultants and external agencies. Accordingly, the findings of this research will be of interest to international marketers both in Australia and overseas. The findings in this research offers some initial evidence on the factors influencing the development of international marketing strategy that Australian international marketers, including exporters, as well as firms using other entry modes into international markets may find useful. The results of the research findings are applicable to firms of different sizes and it has the potential to be the basis of building a decision support system for the development of a firm's international marketing strategy. Finally, the research findings will be useful for government agencies like Austrade and other states and territories’ trade and investment offices that provide specialist help in international marketing to increase their clients’ exports to overseas markets, and raise Australia’s international competitiveness. Overall, this research has both academic and practical implications. For practitioners, the research findings contribute to better and improved 219 understanding of the key factors influencing international marketing strategy development which will positively impact directly on their business in foreign markets. For academics, it provides empirical evidence and opens up potential new areas for further research. 5.5 Limitations of this Research In regard to this research, some of the major limitations are as follows: (1) Geographic limitation - Australia is a small, open economy and a relatively minor player internationally with less than two percent share of the world GDP and less than one percent share of the annual international trade in 2007 (World Trade Organization 2008). As this research has been carried out in Australia only, the findings of this research may not be considered as an international phenomenon. To determine international validity, these tests need to be replicated with similar firms in other countries. (2) Weightings limitation - Another limitation of this research is that the findings of the variables are reflective of the international marketing strategy development behaviour of successful exporters in Australia. This research identifies the factors that affect the development process of international marketing strategy and the measurement scales of each of those factors. It does not take into consideration the individual weighting that may be assigned by each firms to those factors and its measurement scales. (3) Time limitation - Time may be a factor in the development and implementation of an international marketing strategy. An international 220 marketing strategy that has the potential for a particular product/service today may not continue to have the same potential in a couple of years. Similarly, an international marketing strategy that is not appropriate today may turn out to hold potential in the future. This research does not examine the time factor and its importance in the development of an international marketing strategy. 5.6 Future Research This pioneering study conducted among the successful Australian exporters has the potential to open up new areas of empirical research. Similar studies may be conducted among firms that are not that successful in international marketing, to identify the processes and factors they consider when developing their international marketing strategy. The focus of this research has identified the factors influencing the development of an international marketing strategy. Other similar research can be undertaken to determine the process and factors affecting the development of a marketing strategy for the domestic markets as well as for the development of functional, business and corporate strategies for any organisations. The findings from this study are relevant only for Australian firms. As Australia is a relatively small player in the international business arena, such findings may or may not be representative of successful international marketing in other countries. For the sake of generalisation, similar research needs to be conducted among international marketers of other countries of the world. 221 Whilst the respondents in this study are all international marketers, some with joint ventures and/or direct investments in overseas countries; the majority category are exporters as shown in the classification of data in Chapter Four. Thus, further research can be undertaken to test other market entry mode firms, to confirm this research applicability in different business environments. Findings of this research have identified the factors that are considered in the development of an international marketing strategy. This research has also identified the observed variables that measure those factors. However, this research did not measure the relative importance of each of those factors and variables in the international marketing strategy development process for different firms. In reality, although each of those factors and associated variables are included in their development of international marketing strategy, it may well be the case that different firms put different weighting on the factors and variables. While it was not an objective of this research to find out such relative importance, if any, future research may be conducted to establish whether individual firms will need to assign a firm-specific numerical weight to each factor and variable to indicate their relative importance in the development of the international marketing strategy process. One major finding of the research is the importance of the parent firm's guidelines in the development of an international marketing strategy, especially for companies who are subsidiaries of MNCs. With increasing numbers of Australian businesses being taken over by foreign firms, this issue will have major implications in defining the international activities of such 222 businesses. Further research in this area needs to be conducted to assess such implications. Another interesting research finding was that firms whose business model is virtual and operations rooted solely on the Internet World Wide Web do not take into consideration any factors in the foreign markets when developing their international marketing strategy compared to traditional businesses. These unique phenomena and differences in the development of strategies among virtual knowledge-based businesses using the World Wide Web as a global marketplace need further research as we move into a borderless new economy in the future. 5.7 Conclusion The development of international marketing strategy is fundamental to the success of any business attempting to market their products and/or services overseas. There are many factors, both internal and external that impact on the decisions in the development of international marketing strategy. This research will examine the international marketing strategy practices of successful Australian exporters; investigate what factors these businesses consider and how these factors are related to the effectiveness of the strategy development decisions. Hence, the objective of this study is to explore the research problem relating to determining the factors considered by Australian successful exporters in developing their international marketing strategies and the relationship, if any between the strategic developmental decisions and a range of context variables. The findings of this research will benefit both the 223 academic and practitioner arena, contributing to a better and improved understanding of the factors influencing the development of international marketing strategies that would lead to an increase in Australia’s successful exports to overseas markets. The target population selected for this study were all successful Australian exporters who were either finalists or winners of the various categories of the Australian Export Awards for the five years from 2003 to 2007. This study was carried out solely in Australia from January 2007 to February 2010. The mixed methods research methodology employed in this study includes qualitative methods through in-depth interviews in the exploratory research stage and quantitative methods using an online survey questionnaire in the descriptive and causal research stage to test the hypotheses developed from the literature review. From the literature review carried out, several factors were found that have an impact on the decisions for the development of international marketing strategy. These include market and industry factors in both domestic and foreign markets, the firm’s internal factors, foreign environmental factors and public and private support networks in the foreign markets. Thus, four hypotheses were developed based on these factors to be tested in the descriptive and explanatory research. These factors were further validated in the qualitative study. Subsequently, an online survey instrument in the form of a questionnaire was designed with all of these factors as variables to be emailed to a sample of respondents selected randomly from the target population. The collected data 224 was screened, cleaned and several statistical tests were performed using SPSS version 14.0 for Windows software to analyse the data. However, due to the lack of statistically significant results from the analysis of the survey data, the four hypotheses were not supported. It is believed that this study is one of the few undertaken to examine the factors influencing the development of international marketing strategy of Australian exporters. It is hoped that future research will replicate this study in other countries. Such studies will not only substantiate this research, but also offer new insights into understanding the factors influencing the decisions in the development of an international marketing strategy on a global basis. 225 REFERENCES Aaby, N. & Slater, S. F. 1989, 'Management influences on export performance: A review of the empirical literature 1978 -1988', International Marketing Review, vol. 6, no. 4, pp. 7-26. Aaker, D. A. 2007, Strategic marketing management, 8th edn, Wiley, New York. Aaker, D. A., Kumar, V. & Day, G. S. 2004, Marketing research, 8th edn, Wiley, New Jersey. Akyol, A. & Akehurst, G. 2003, 'An investigation of export performance variations related to corporate export market orientation', European Business Review, vol. 15, no. 1, pp. 5-19. Albaum, G. & Tse, D. 2001, 'Adaptation of international marketing components, competitive advantage, and firm performance: A study of Hong Kong exporters', Journal of International Marketing, vol. 9, no. 4, pp. 59-81. Aldrich, H. E. 1979, Organizations and environments, Prentice-Hall, Engelwood Cliffs, New Jersey. Almquist, E. & Wyner, G. 2001, 'Boost your marketing ROI with experimental design', Harvard Business Review, vol. 97, no. 9, pp. 135-51. Andrews, D., Nonnecke, B. & Preece, J. 2003, 'Electronic survey methodology: A case study in reaching hard-to-involve Internet users', International Journal of Human-Computer Interaction, vol. 16, no. 2, pp. 185210. Ansoff, H. I. 1965, Corporate Strategy, McGraw-Hill, NY. Argenti, J. 1980, Practical corporate planning, George Allen & Unwin, London. Australia Department of Foreign Affairs and Trade 2009, 'Australia fact sheet', Market Information and Research Section, DFAT, Canberra. Australian Department of Foreign Affairs and Trade 2008, 'Review of export policies and programs', DFAT, Canberra. Axinn, C. 1998, 'Export performance: Do managerial perceptions make a difference?', International Marketing Review, vol. 5, no. 2, pp. 61-71. Bailey, A. & Johnson, G. 1995, 'Strategy development processes: A configurational approach', Academy of Management Journal, vol. 2, no. 6, pp. 2-6. Bailey, A., Johnson, G. & Daniels, K. 2000, 'Validation of a multi-dimensional measure of strategy development processes', British Journal of Management, vol. 11, no. 2, pp. 151-62. 226 Bartels, R. 1968, 'Are domestic and international marketing dissimilar?', Journal of Marketing, vol. 32, no. 3, pp. 56-61. Bartol, K., Mattin, D., Tein, M. & Matthews, G. 2004, Management: A Pacific rim focus, 4th edn, McGraw-Hill, Sydney. Bass, B. M. 1983, Organizational decision making, Irwin, Illinois. Bearden, W., Netemeyer, R. & Mobley, M. 1993, Handbook of marketing scales: Multi-item measures for marketing and consumer behavior research, Sage, Newbury Park, California. Bennett, R. & Blythe, J. 2002, International marketing: Strategy planning, market entry & implementation Kogan Page, London. Bennis, W. & Nanus, B. 1985, Leaders: The strategies for taking charge, Harper & Rowe, New York. Berg, B. L. 2007, 'A dramaturgical look at interviewing', in Qualitative research methods for the social sciences, Allyn & Bacon, Boston. Bertil, O. 1933, Interregional and international trade, Harvard University Press, Cambridge, Massachusetts. Bharadwaj, S. G., Varadarajan, R. & Fahy, J. 1993, 'Sustainable competitive advantage in service industries: A conceptual model and research propositions', Journal of Marketing, vol. 57, no. 4, pp. 83-96. Boddewyn, J. J., Soehl, R. & Picard, J. 1986, 'Standardization in international marketing: Is Ted Levitt in fact right?', Business Horizons, vol. 29, no. 6, pp. 69-75. Bourgeois, L. J. & Brodwin, D. R. 1984, 'Strategy implementation: Five approaches to an elusive phenomenon', Strategic Management Journal, vol. 5, no. 3, pp. 214-64. Bower, J. L. 1970, 'Planning within the firm', The American Economic Review, vol. 60, no. 2, pp. 186-94. Bower, J. L. 1986, Managing the resource allocation process: A study of corporate planning and investment, Harvard Business School Press, Watertown, Massachusetts. Brace, I. 2004, Questionnaire design, Kogan Page Ltd, London. Bradford, R. W. & Duncan, J. P. 1999, Simplified strategic planning: A nononsense guide for busy people who want results fast, Chandler House Press, Worcester, Massachusetts. Bradley, F. 2005, International marketing strategy, 5th edn, Pearson Education Ltd, Essex. 227 Browne, M. 1993, Organizational decision-making and information, Ablex, Norwood, New Jersey. Bruner, G., II & Hensel, P. 1992, Marketing scales handbook - A compilation of multi-item measures, American Marketing Association, Chicago. Bryson, J. M. 2004, Strategic planning for public and non-profit organizations: A guide to strengthening and sustaining organizational achievement, 3rd edn, Jossey Bass, San Francisco, California. Buchanan, D. & Boddy, D. 1992, The expertise of the change agent: Public performance and backstage activities, Prentice Hall, New Jersey. Buckley, P. J. & Ghauri, P. N. 2006, The internationalization of the firm, Thomson Learning, London. Burgelman, R. A. 1983a, 'A model of the interaction of strategic behavior, corporate context and the concept of strategy', Academy of Management Review, vol. 81, no. 1, pp. 61-70. Burgelman, R. A. 1983b, 'A process model of internal corporate venturing in the major diversified firm', Administrative Science Quarterly, vol. 28, pp. 22344. Buzzell, R. D. 1968, 'Can you standardize multinational marketing?', Harvard Business Review, vol. 46, no. 6, pp. 102-13. Cavusgil, S. & Naor, J. 1987, 'Firm and management characteristics as discriminators of export marketing activity', Journal of Business Research, vol. 15, no. 3, pp. 221-35. Cavusgil, S. & Nevin, J. R. 1981, 'Internal determinants of export marketing behavior: An empirical investigation', Journal of Marketing Research, vol. 18, no. 1, pp. 114-9. Cavusgil, S. & Zou, S. 1994, 'Marketing strategy - performance relationship: An investigation of the empirical link in export market ventures', Journal of Marketing, vol. 58, no. 1, pp. 1-21. Chan, R. & Wong, Y. 1999, 'Bank generic strategies: Does Porter's theory apply in an international banking centre', International Business Review, vol. 8, no. 5-6, pp. 561-90. Christensen, C., Rocha, A. d. & Gertner, R. 1987, 'An empirical investigation of the factors influencing export success of Brazilian firms', Journal of International Business Studies, vol. 18, no. 3, pp. 61-78. Chung, H. F. L. 2003, 'International standardization strategies: The experiences of Australian and New Zealand firms operating in the Greater China markets', Journal of International Marketing, vol. 11, no. 3, pp. 48-82. 228 Clarke, I. & Mackaness, W. 2001, 'Management intuition: An interpretative account of structure and content of decision schemas using cognitive maps', Journal of Management Studies, vol. 38, no. 2, pp. 147-72. Coakes, S. & Steed, L. 2007, SPSS: Analysis without anguish - Version 14.0 for Windows, John Wiley & Sons Australia Ltd, Milton, Queensland. Cohen, S. & Zysman, J. 1988, Manufacturing matters: The myth of the postindustrial economy, Basic Books, New York. Cooper, R. G. & Kleinschmidt, E. 1985, 'The impact of export strategy on export sales performance', Journal of International Business Studies, vol. 16, no. 1, pp. 37-43. Courtney, J. 2001, 'Decision making and knowledge management in inquiring organizations: Toward a new decision-making paradigm for DSS', Decision Support Systems, vol. 31, no. 1, pp. 17-38. Craig, C. S. & Douglas, S. P. 2000, 'Configural advantage in global markets', Journal of International Marketing, vol. 8, no. 1, pp. 6-25. Crespy, C., Miller, V. & Becker, T. 1993, ' Export benchmarking: Export practices associated with superior performance', Journal of Business & Industrial Marketing, vol. 8, no. 1, pp. 36-44. Creswell, J. W. 2003, Research design: Qualitative, quantitative, and mixed methods approaches, 2nd edn, Sage, Thousand Oaks, California. Creswell, J. W. & Plano Clark, V. L. 2007, Designing and conducting mixed methods research, Sage, Thousand Oaks, California. Creswell, J. W., Plano Clark, V. L., Gutmann, M. & Hanson, W. 2003, 'Advanced mixed methods research designs', in Handbook of mixed methods in social and behavioral research, eds A. Tashakkori and C. Teddlie, Sage, Thousand Oaks, California, pp. 209-40. Cyert, R. & March, J. 1963, Behavioral theory of the firm, Prentice Hall, Englewood Cliffs. New Jersey. Czinkota, M. R. & Ronkanien, I. 2006, International marketing, 8th edn, Thomson South-Western College Publishing, Mason, Ohio. Dailey, M. & Carley, S. 2003, 'The future of global consumer cultures', in Cross-cultural marketing, eds R. Rugimbana and S. Nwankwo, Nelson Thomson Learning, Melbourne, pp. 322-7. Dalgic, T. & Heijblom, R. 1996, 'Educator insights: International marketing blunders revisited - Some lessons for managers', Journal of International Marketing, vol. 4, no. 1, pp. 81-91. Daniels, J. & Radebaugh, L. 2007, International business: Environments and operations, 11th edn, Addision-Wesley, Reading, Massachusetts. 229 Darlin, D. 1988, 'Japanese learn thrills of bargain shopping from mentors aboard', in The Wall Street Journal. Davis, D. 2005, Business research for decision making, 6th edn, Thomson South-Western, Mason, Ohio. Day, G. S. 1999, Market driven strategy: Process for creating value, Free Press, New York. Day, G. S. 2007, The market driven organization - Understanding, attracting and keeping valuable customers, The Free Press, New York. Day, G. S. & Wensley, R. 1988, 'Assessing advantage: A framework for diagnosing competitive superiority', Journal of Marketing, vol. 52, no. 2, pp. 120. Deal, T. E. & Kennedy, A. A. 1982, Corporate culture, Addison-Wesley, Reading, Massachusetts. Deephouse, D. L. 1996, 'Does isomorphism legitimate?', Academy of Management Journal, vol. 39, no. 4, pp. 1024-39. Denzin, N. & Lincoln, Y. (eds) 2003, Strategies of qualitative inquiry, Sage, Thousand Oaks, California. Denzin, N. & Lincoln, Y. (eds) 2005, The sage handbook of qualitative research, 3rd edn, Sage, Thousand Oaks, California. Denzin, N. & Lincoln, Y. 2008, Collecting and interpreting qualitative materials, 3rd edn, Sage, Thousand Oaks, California. Dess, G. 1987, 'Consensus on strategy formulation and organizational performance: Competitors in a fragmented industry', Strategic Management Journal, vol. 8, no. 3, pp. 259-60. Dicken, P. 2003, Global shift: Reshaping the global economic map in the 21st century, 4th edn, Guilford Press, New York. DiMaggio, P. & Powell, W. 1983, 'The iron cage revisited: Institutional isomorphism and collective rationality in organizational fields', American Sociological Review, vol. 48, no. 2, pp. 147-60. Doole, I. 2000, How SME learn to compete effectively on international markets, Sheffield Hallam University. Doole, I. & Lowe, R. 2003, 'Cross-cultural marketing for SMEs', in Crosscultural marketing, eds R. Rugimbana and S. Nwankwo, Nelson Thomson Learning, Melbourne, pp. 298-321. Doole, I. & Lowe, R. 2005, Strategic marketing decisions in global markets Thomson Learning, London. 230 Doole, I. & Lowe, R. 2008, International marketing strategy: Analysis, development and implementation, 5th edn, Thomson Learning, London. Doty, D. H., Click, W. H. & Huber, C. P. 1993, 'Fit, equifinality, and organizational effectiveness: A test of two configurational theories', Academy of Management Journal, vol. 36, no. 6, pp. 1196-250. Douglas, S. P. & Wind, Y. 1987, 'The myth of globalization', Columbia Journal of World Business, vol. 22, no. 4, pp. 47-58. Doz, Y. 1987, 'International industries: Fragmentation versus globalization', in Technology and global Industry, ed Guile, Bruce, R and Brooks, H, National Academy Press, Washington, D.C. Drucker, P. 1977, 'The rise of production sharing', The Wall Street Journal, March 15. Drucker, P. 2007, Management: Tasks, responsibilities, practices, Transcation Publishers, New Jersey. Drucker, P., Hammond, J., Keeney, R., Raiffa, H. & Hayashi, A. M. 2001, Harvard Business Review on Decision Making, Harvard Business School Press, Boston, Massachusetts. Eisenhardt, K. M. & Zbaracki, M. J. 1992, 'Strategic decision making', Strategic Management Journal, vol. 13, no. 2, pp. 17-37. Elbing, A. 1978, Behavioural decisions in organisations, 2nd edn, Scoot, Foresman & Co., London. Ethier, W. 1997, Modern international economics, 3rd edn, W.W. Norton & Co. Inc., New York. Faaborg, O., Gesteland, R. & Noergaard, E. 2005, International marketing, cultures and communication: A resource book for students of international business, Publizon A/S, Copenhagen. Faulkner, D. 2002, Strategy: Critical perspectives on business and management, Taylor & Francis, London. Feenstra, R. 1998, 'Integration of trade and disintegration of production in the global economy', The Journal of Economic Perspectives, vol. 12, no. 4, pp. 31-50. Feldman, S. P. 1986, 'Management in context: An essay on the relevance of culture to the understanding of organizational change', Journal of Management Studies, vol. 23, no. 6, pp. 587-607. Field, A. 2009, Discovering statistics using SPSS, 3rd edn, Sage Publications Ltd, London. 231 Fifield, P. & Lewis, K. 1998, International Marketing Strategy, ButterworthHeinemann, Oxford. Fletcher, R. & Brown, L. 2005, International marketing: An Asia-Pacific perspective, 3rd edn, Pearson Prentice Hall, Frenchs Forest, New South Wales. Flick, U. 1992, 'Triangulation revisited: Strategy of validation or alternative?', Journal for the Theory of Social Behaviour, vol. 22, no. 2, pp. 175-97. Frey, B. 1986, International political economics, Basil Blackwell Inc., New York. Gaulier, G., Lemoine, F. & Ünal-Kesenci, D. 2007, 'China’s integration in East Asia: Production sharing, FDI and high-tech trade', Economic Change and Restructuring, vol. 40, no. 1-2, pp. 27-63. Gioia, D. A. & Poole, P. P. 1984, 'Scripts in organizational behavior', Academy of Management Review, vol. 9, no. 3, pp. 449-59. Glaser, B. G. & Strauss, A. 1967, The discovery of grounded theory: Strategies for qualitative research, Aldine, Chicago. Golfetto, F. & Gibbert, M. 2006, 'Marketing competencies and the sources of customer value in business markets', Industrial Marketing Management, vol. 35, no. 8, pp. 904-12. Greene, J. C., Caracelli, V. J. & Graham, W. F. 1989, 'Toward a conceptual framework for mixed-method evaluation designs ', Educational Evaluation and Policy Analysis, vol. 11, no. 3, pp. 255-74. Griffin, R. & Pustay, M. 2007, International business - A managerial perspective, 5th edn, Pearson Prentice Hall, Upper Saddle River, New Jersey. Grossman, G. & Helpman, E. 1989, 'Product development and international trade', The Journal of Political Economy, vol. 97, no. 6, pp. 1261-83. Groves, R. M. 2004, Survey errors and survey costs, Wiley Interscience, New York. Guba, E. G. 1990, 'The alternative paradigm dialog', in Paradigm dialog, ed E.G. Guba, Sage, Newbury Park, California, pp. 17-30. Guba, E. G. & Lincoln, Y. S. 2005, 'Paradigmatic controversies, contradictions, and emerging confluences', in Handbook of Qualitative Research, eds N.K. Denzin and Y.S. Lincoln, Sage, Thousand Oaks, California, pp. 191-216. Haines, S. 2000, The systems thinking approach to strategy planning and management, St. Lucie Press, Boca Raton, Florida. 232 Hair, J. F., Jr., Anderson, R. E., Tatham, R. L. & Black, W. C. 2006, Multivariate data analysis, 6th edn, Pearson Education Inc., New Jersey. Hair, J. F., Jr., Bush, R. & Ortinau, D. 2003, Marketing research within a changing information environment 2nd edn, McGraw-Hill, Irwin, Illinois. Hamel, G. & Prahalad, C. K. 1985, 'Do you really have a global strategy?', Harvard Business Review, vol. 63, no. 4, pp. 139-48. Hannan, M. T. & Freeman, J. H. 1989, Organizational ecology, Harvard University Press, Boston. Harcourt, T. 2007, 'Going global - Growing the next generation of Australian businesses', Austrade, Canberra. Haridas, T. 1983, 'Qualitative research in organisational behaviour', Journal of Management Studies, vol. 20, no. 3, pp. 301-14. Harrell, S. G. & Taylor, E. D. 1981, 'Modeling the product life cycle for consumer durables', Journal of Marketing, vol. 45, no. 4, pp. 68-75. Harrison, E. 1993, 'Interdisciplinary models of decision-making', Management Decision, vol. 31, no. 8, pp. 27-33. Harrison, F. & Harrison, E. 1999, The managerial decision-making process, 5th edn, Houghton Mifflin, Boston. Hart, S. & Banbury, C. 1994, 'How strategy making processes can make a difference', Strategic Management Journal, vol. 15, no. 4, pp. 251-69. Hartley, R. 2004, Marketing mistakes and successes, 9th edn, John Wiley, New York. Haspeslagh, P. 1982, 'Portfolio planning: Uses and limits', Harvard Business Review, vol. 60, no. 1, pp. 60,73. Heckscher, E. 1949, 'The effects of foreign trade on the distribution of income', in Readings in the Theory of International Trade, ed Ellis, Howard, S. and Metzler, L.A., Allen & Unwin, London. Heckscher, E. & Ohlin, B. 1991, Heckscher-Ohlin trade theory, The MIT Press, Cambridge, Massachusetts. Heenan, D. 1988a, 'The case of convergent capitalism', Journal of Business Strategy, vol. 9, no. 6, pp. 54-7. Heenan, D. 1988b, 'The courtship of the multinational corporation', Journal of Business Strategy, vol. 9, no. 2, pp. 49-52. Henzler, H. & Rail, W. 1986, 'Facing up to the globalization challenge', McKinsey Quarterly, vol. 86, no. 1, pp. 52-68. 233 Hickson, D. J., Butler, R. J., Gray, D., Mallory, G. R. & Wilson, D. C. 1986, Top decisions - Strategic decision-making in organizations, Blackwell, Oxford. Hinings, C. R., Hickson, D. J., Pennings, J. M. & Schneck, R. E. 1974, 'Structural conditions of intraorganizational power', Administrative Science Quarterly, vol. 19, no. 1, pp. 22-4. Hirsch, S. 1965, 'The United States electronic industry in international trade', National Institute Economic Review, vol. 34, no. 24, pp. 92-7. Hirsch, S. 1967, Location of industry and international competitiveness, Claredon Press, Oxford. Hofer, G. W. & Schendel, D. E. 1978, Strategy Formulation: Analytical Concepts, West Publishing, St. Paul, Minn. Hoffman, J. 1997, 'A two stage model for the introduction of products into international markets', Journal of Global Marketing, vol. 11, no. 1, pp. 65-86. Hooley, G., Saunders, J. C. & Piercy, N. 2004, 'Market-led strategic management', in Marketing strategy & competitive positioning, Prentice Hall, London, pp. 3-289. Howells, J. & Wood, M. 1993, The globalisation of production and technology, Belhaven Press, London. Hubbard, G. 2004, Strategic management: Thinking, analysis & action, 2nd edn, Pearson Prentice Hall, Frenchs Forest, New South Wales. Hufbauer, G. 1966, Synthetic materials and the theory of international trade, Duckworth, London. Hunt, S. D. & Morgan, R. M. 1995, 'The comparative advantage theory of competition', Journal of Marketing, vol. 59, no. 2, pp. 1-15. Hutt, M. D., Reingen, P. H. & Ronchetto, J. R. 1988, 'Tracing emergent processes in marketing strategy formation', Journal of Marketing, vol. 52, no. 1, pp. 14-9. Jain, S. C. 1989, 'Standardization of international marketing strategy: Some research hypotheses', Journal of Marketing, vol. 53, no. 1, pp. 70-9. Jain, S. C. 1996, International marketing management, 5th edn, Thomson South-Western College Publishing, Cincinnati, Ohio. Jain, S. C. 2004, Marketing: Planning & strategy, 7th edn, Thomson Custom Publishing, Ohio. Jarratt, D. 2006, 'Strategies for competing in Marketing strategy and plans study guide', ed S. Slowikowski, Charles Strut University, Wagga Wagga, New South Wales, pp. 89-90. 234 Jarratt, D. G. & Fayed, R. 2001, 'The impact of market and organisational challenges on marketing strategy decision-making: A qualitative investigation of the business-to-business sector', Journal of Business Research, vol. 51, no. 1, pp. 61-72. Jaworski, B. J. & Kohli, A. K. 1993, 'Market orientation: Antecedents and consequences', Journal of Marketing, vol. 57, no. 3, pp. 53-70. Jaworski, B. J. & Kohli, A. K. 1996, 'Market orientation: Review, refinement, and roadmap', Journal of Market Focused Management, vol. 1, no. 2, pp. 11933. Jeannet, J. & Hennessey, D. 2004, Global marketing strategies, 6th edn, Houghton Mifflin Co., Boston. Johansson, J. 2005, Global marketing: Foreign entry, local marketing, and global management, 4th edn, Irwin McGraw-Hill, Boston. Johnson, G. 1987, Strategic change and the management process, Blackwell, Oxford. Johnson, G. 1988, 'Re-thinking incrementalism', Strategic Management Journal, vol. 9, pp. 75-91. Johnson, G., Scholes, K. & Whittington, R. 2005, 'Understanding strategy development', in Exploring corporate strategy, Prentice Hall, Harlow, pp. 563609. Johnson, R. B. & Onwuegbuzie, A. J. 2004, 'Mixed methods research: A research paradigm whose time has come', Educational Researcher, vol. 33, no. 7, pp. 14-26. Josephs, R., Larrick, R., Steele, C. & Nisbett, R. 1992, 'Protecting the self from the negative consequences of risky decisions', Journal of Personality and Social Psychology, vol. 62, no. 1, pp. 26-37. Julian, C. C. & Ahmed, Z. U. 2005, 'The impact of barriers to export on export marketing performance', Journal of Global Marketing, vol. 19, no. 1, pp. 71 94. Julian, C. C. & O'Cass, A. 2004, 'The antecedents of export marketing performance: An Australian perspective', Journal of Asia Pacific Marketing, vol. 3, no. 2, pp. 99 -113. Kapferer, J. N. 2004, 'The new strategic brand management: Creating and sustaining brand equity long term', Kogan Page, London. Keegan, W. J. 2001, Global marketing management, 7th edn, Prentice-Hall, Upper Saddle River, New Jersey. Keegan, W. J. & Green, M. 1997, Principles of global marketing, PrenticeHall, Upper Saddle River, New Jersey. 235 Keegan, W. J. & Green, M. S. 2007, Global marketing 5th edn, Prentice-Hall, Upper Saddle River, New Jersey. Kenen, P. 2000, The international economy, 3rd edn, Cambridge University Press, Cambridge. Ketchen, D. J., Combs, J. C., Russell, C. J., Shook, C., Dean, M. A., Runge, J., Lohrke, F. T., Naumann, S. E., Haptonstahl, D. E., Baker, R., Beckstein, B. A., Handler, C., Honig, H. & Lamoureux, S. 1997, 'Organizational configurations and performance: A meta-analysis', Academy of Management Journal vol. 40, no. 1, pp. 223-40. Kim, W. C. & Mauborgne, R. 2008, 'Blue ocean strategy', Leadership Excellence, vol. 25, no. 12, p. 6. Knight, G. 2000, 'Entrepreneurship and marketing strategy: The SME under globalization', Journal of International Marketing, vol. 8, no. 2, pp. 12-32. Knight, G. A. 1995, 'Educator insights: International marketing blunders by American firms in Japan - Some lessons for management', Journal of International Marketing, vol. 3, no. 4, pp. 107-29. Koh, A. 1991, 'Relationships among organisational characteristics, marketing strategy and export performance', International Marketing Review, vol. 8, no. 3, pp. 46 - 60. Kohli, A. K. & Jaworski, B. J. 1990, 'Market orientations: The construct, research propositions and managerial implications', Journal of Marketing, vol. 54, no. 2, pp. 1-18. Kotler, P. 1986, 'Global standardization: Courting danger', Journal of Consumer Marketing, vol. 3, no. 2, pp. 13-5. Kotler, P. 1999, Marketing management: Analysis, planning, implementation and control, 8th edn, Prentice Hall, New Jersey. Kotler, P. & Keller, K. L. 2006, Marketing management, 12th edn, Pearson Prentice Hall, New Jersey. Kotter, J. P. 1990, A force for change: How leadership differs from management, Free Press, New York. Krugman, P. 1983, 'New theories of trade among industrial countries', The American Economic Review, vol. 73, no. 2, pp. 343-7. Krugman, P. 1994, Rethinking international trade, The MIT Press, Cambridge, Massachusetts. Krugman, P. & Obstfield, M. 2006, International economics: Theory and policy, 7th edn, Addison Wesley, Boston. 236 Kuehn, A. & Day, R. 1962, 'Strategy of product quality', Harvard Business Review, vol. 40, no. 6, pp. 101-2. Kumar, K., Stam, A. & Joachimsthaler, E. A. 1993, 'An interactive multicriteria approach to identifying potential foreign markets', Journal of International Marketing, vol. 2, no. 1, pp. 29-54. Lages, L. 2000, 'A conceptual framework of the determinants of export performance: Reorganising key variables and shifting contingencies in export marketing', Journal of Global Marketing, vol. 13, no. 3, pp. 29-51. Lages, L. F. & Montgomery, D. 2004, 'Export performance as an antecedent of export commitment and marketing strategy adaptation: Evidence from small and medium-sized exporters', European Journal of Marketing, vol. 38, no. 9/10, pp. 1186-214. Langley, A. 1989, 'In search of rationality: The purposes behind the use of formal analysis in organizations', Administrative Science Quarterly, vol. 34, no. 4, pp. 598-631. Laroche, M., Kirpalani, V. H., Pons, F. & Lianxi, Z. 2001, 'A model of advertising standardization in multinational corporations', Journal of International Business Studies, vol. 32, no. 2, pp. 249-66. Larrick, R. P. 1993, 'Motivational factors in decision theories: The role of self protection', Psychological Bulletin, vol. 113, no. 3, pp. 440-50. Lather, P. 1986, 'Issues in validity in openly ideological research: Between a rock and a hard place', Interchange, vol. 17, no. 4, pp. 63-84. Lawson, R. & Shen, Z. 1998, Organisational psychology: Foundations and applications, Oxford University Press, Oxford. Leonidou, L. C. 1995, 'Empirical research on export barriers: Review, assessment and synthesis ', Journal of International Marketing, vol. 3, no. 1, pp. 29-43. Leonidou, L. C., Katsikea, C. S. & Piercy, N. F. 1998, 'Identifying managerial influences on exporting: Past research and future directions', Journal of International Marketing, vol. 6, no. 2, pp. 74-102. Leonidou, L. C., Katsikeas, C. S. & Samiee, S. 2002, 'Marketing strategy determinants of export performance: A meta-analysis', Journal of Business Research, vol. 55, no. 1, pp. 51 - 67. Letto-Gillies, G. 1994, International production: Trends, theories, effects, Polity Press, Cambridge. Levine, H. G. 1985, 'Principles of data storage and retrieval for use in qualitative evaluations', Educational Evaluation and Policy Analysis, vol. 7, no. 2, pp. 169-86. 237 Levitt, T. 1983, 'The globalization of markets', Harvard Business Review, vol. 61, no. 3, pp. 92-102. Lim, L. K., Acito, F. & Rusetski, A. 2006, 'Development of archetypes of international marketing strategy', Journal of International Business Studies, vol. 37, no. 4, pp. 499-524. Lincoln, Y. & Guba, E. 1985, 'Establishing trustworthiness', in Naturalistic Inquiry, eds Y. Lincoln and E. Guba, Sage, Beverly Hills, California, pp. 397444. Lindblom, C. E. 1959, 'The science of "muddling through"', Public Administration Review, vol. 19, no. 2, pp. 79-88. Lindell, M. K. & Whitney, D. J. 2001, 'Accounting for common method variance in cross-sectional designs', Journal of Applied Psychology, vol. 86, no. 1, pp. 114-21. Ling-Yee, L. & Ogunmokun, G. 2001, 'Effect of export financing resources and supply-chain skills on export competitive advantages: Implications for superior export performance', Journal of World Business, vol. 36, no. 3, pp. 260-79. Louter, P. J., Ouwerkerk, C. & Ben, B. 1991, 'An inquiry into successful exporting', European Journal of Marketing vol. 25, no. 6, pp. 7 - 23. Lu, V. & Julian, C. C. 2008, 'The Internet, strategy and performance: A study of Australian export market ventures', Journal of Global Marketing, vol. 21 no. 3, pp. 231 - 40. Madsen, T. 1989, 'Successful export marketing management: Some empirical evidence', International Marketing Review, vol. 16, no. 4, pp. 41-57. Maitland, E. & Nicholas, S. 2002, 'Internationalization of Australian firms in Asia', International Studies of Management and Organizations, vol. 32, no. 1, pp. 79 -108. Malhotra, N. K. 2006, Marketing research: An applied orientation, 3rd edn, Prentice Hall, Frenchs Forest, New South Wales. Malhotra, N. K., Agarwal, J. & Ulgado, F. M. 2003, 'Internationalization and entry modes: A multitheoretical framework and research propositions', Journal of International Marketing, vol. 11, no. 4, pp. 1-31. Mancuso, C. A. & Charlson, M. E. 1995, 'Does recollection error threaten the validity of cross-sectional studies of effectiveness?', Medical Care, vol. 33, no. 4, pp. 77-88. Mann, C. J. 2003, 'Observational research methods. Research design II: cohort, cross sectional, and case-control studies', Emergency Medicine Journal, vol. 20, no. 1, pp. 54-60. 238 Manning, M. & Munro, D. 2004, 'Analysing survey questionnaire in SPSS', Southern Cross University, Lismore, New South Wales. Manning, M. & Munro, D. 2006, The survey researcher's SPSS cookbook, Pearson Education Australia, Frenchs Forest, New South Wales. March, J. & Simon, H. 1993, Organizations, 2nd edn, Wiley-Blackwell, Cambridge, Massachusetts. Markides, C. C. & Williamson, P. J. 1994, 'Related diversification, core competencies and corporate performance', Strategic Management Journal, vol. 15, no. S2, pp. 149-65. Markusen, J., Melvin, J., Kaempfer, W. & Maskus, K. 1995, International trade: Theory and evidence, International edn, McGraw-Hill Inc., New York. McLarney, C. 2003, 'A driving force: An analysis of strategic planning in the Canadian automotive industry', Business Process Management Journal, vol. 9, no. 4, pp. 421-39. Mclver, J. 2002, Macroeconomics, 6th edn, McGraw Hill, Sydney. McMurray, D. W. 2006, 'Qualitative research methods study guide', Southern Cross University, Tweed Heads, New South Wales. Melon Media 2008, 'Newsletter on survey technique', Sydney. Menon, A., Bharadwaj, S. G., Adidam, P. T. & Edison, S. W. 1999, 'Antecedents and consequences of marketing strategy making: A model and a test', Journal of Marketing, vol. 63, no. 2, pp. 18-40. Merriam, S. 1997, Case study research in education, Jossey Bass, San Francisco. Meyer, A. D., Tsui, A. S. & Hinings, C. R. 1993, 'Configurational approaches to organizational analysis', Academy of Management Journal, vol. 36, no. 6, pp. 1175-95. Miles, M. B. & Huberman, A. M. 1994, Qualitative data analysis: An expanded sourcebook, 2nd edn, Sage, Newbury Park, California. Miller, A. & Dess, G. 1993, 'Assessing Porter's (1980) model in terms of its generalizability, accuracy and simplicity', Journal of Management Studies, vol. 30, no. 4, pp. 553-85. Miller, D. 1981, 'Toward a new contingency approach: The search for organizational gestalts', Journal of Management Studies, vol. 18, no. 1, pp. 126. Miller, D. 1986, 'Configurations of strategy and structure: Towards a synthesis', Strategic Management Journal, vol. 7, no. 3, pp. 233-49. 239 Miller, D. 1992, 'A framework for integrated risk management in international business', Journal of International Business Studies, vol. 23, no. 2, pp. 31131. Miller, D. 1996, 'Configurations revisited', Strategic Management Journal, vol. 17, no. 7, pp. 505-12. Miller, D. & Mintzberg, H. 1983, 'The case for configuration', in Beyond method: Strategies for social research, ed G. Morgan, Sage, Beverly Hills, California, pp. 57-73. Minkes, A. 1987, The entrepreneurial manager: Decisions, goals and business ideas, Penguin, Harmondsworth. Mintzberg, H. 1978, 'Patterns of strategy formation', Management Science, vol. 24, no. 9, pp. 934-48. Mintzberg, H. 1987, 'Five Ps for Strategy', California Management Review, vol. Fall. Mintzberg, H. 1994, The rise and fall of strategic planning, Prentice Hall, New Jersey. Mintzberg, H., Ahlstrand, B. & Lampel, J. 2008, Strategy safari: The complete guide through the wilds of strategic management, 2nd edn, Prentice Hall, New Jersey. Mintzberg, H., Lampel, J., Quinn, J. & Ghoshal, S. 2002, The strategy process: Concepts, context, cases, 4th edn, Prentice Hall, New York. Mintzberg, H., Raisinghani, D. & Theoret, A. 1976, 'The structure of "unstructured" decision processes', Administrative Science Quarterly, vol. 21, no. 2, pp. 246-75. Mintzberg, H. & Waters, J. A. 1985, 'Of strategies, deliberate and emergent', Strategic Management Journal, vol. 6, no. 3, pp. 257-72. Misenbock, K. 1988, 'Small business and exporting: A literature review', International Small Business Journal, vol. 6, no. 2, pp. 42-61. Mitchell, O. & Bradley, F. 1986, 'Export commitment in the firm - Strategic or opportunistic behaviour', Journal of Irish Business and Administrative Research, vol. 8, no. 2, pp. 12-9. Mittal, V. 2001, 'Driving customer equity: How customer lifetime value is reshaping corporate strategy', Journal of Marketing, vol. 65, no. 2, pp. 107-9. Moini, A. H. 1995, 'An inquiry into successful exporting : An empirical investigation using a three-stage model', Journal of Small Business Management, vol. 33, no. 3, pp. 9-23. 240 Moini, A. H. 1997, 'Barriers inhibiting export performance of small and medium-sized manufacturing firms', Journal of Global Marketing, vol. 10, no. 4, pp. 67-93. Morgan, R. & Hunt, S. 1999, 'Relationship-based competitive advantage: The role of relationship marketing in marketing strategy', Journal of Business Research, vol. 46, no. 3, pp. 281-90. Morrison, A., Ricks, D. & Roth, K. 1991, 'Globalization versus regionalization: Which way for the multinational?', Organizational Dynamics, vol. 19, no. 3, pp. 17-29. Morse, J. M. 1994, 'Designing funded qualitative research', in Handbook of qualitative research, eds N.K. Denzin and Y.S. Lincoln, Sage, Thousand Oaks, Calfornia. Muhlbacher, H., Dahringer, L. & Helmuth, L. 1999, 'International marketing strategy - The key to success', in International marketing: A global perspective, International Business Thomson Business Press, London, pp. 39-78. Nachmias, D. 2000, Research methods in the social sciences, 6th edn, Worth Publishers, New York. Naisbitt, J. 1994, Global paradox: The bigger the world economy, the more powerful its smallest players, Allen & Unwin, London. Narver, J. C. & Slater, S. F. 1990, 'The effect of a marketing orientation on business profitability', Journal of Marketing, vol. 54, no. 4, pp. 20-35. National Advisory Mental Health Council 1996, 'Basic behavioral science research for mental health: Thought and communication', American Psychologist, vol. 51, no. 3, pp. 181-9. Neuman, W. L. 2006, Social research methods: Qualitative and quantitative approaches, 6th edn, Pearson, Boston. Ng, F. & Yeats, A. 1999, 'Production sharing in East Asia: Who does what for whom and why', The World Bank Research Development Group, Washington, D.C. Noda, T. & Bower, J. 1996, 'Strategy as iterated processes of resource allocation', Strategic Management Journal, vol. 17, no. S1, pp. 159-92. Nonaka, I. 1988, 'Towards middle-up-down management: Accelerating information creation', Sloan Management Review, vol. 29, no. 3, pp. 9-18. Nulty, P. 1990, 'How the world will change', Fortune Magazine, January 15, p. 45. Nutt, P. C. 1987, 'Identifying and appraising how managers install strategy', Strategic Management Journal, vol. 8, no. 1, pp. 1-14. 241 O'Cass, A. & Julian, C. C. 2003, 'Examining firm and environmental influences on export marketing mix strategy and export performance of Australian exporters', European Journal of Marketing, vol. 37, no. 3-4, pp. 366 - 84. Ogunmokun, G. & Ng, S. 2004, 'Factors influencing export performance in international marketing: A study of Australian firms', International Journal of Management, vol. 21, no. 2, pp. 172 - 85. Ogunmokun, G. & Wong, J. 2004, 'Determinants of marketing adaptation / globalisation practices of Australian exporting firms', World Review of Science, Technology and Sustainable Development, vol. 1, no. 1, pp. 81 - 92. Ohmae, K. 1989, 'Managing in a borderless world', Harvard Business Review, vol. 67, no. 3, pp. 152-61. Ozsomer, A. & Prussia, G. E. 2000, 'Competing perspectives in international marketing strategy: contingency and process models', Journal of International Marketing, vol. 8, no. 1, pp. 27-50. Patton, M. Q. 2002, Qualitative research and evaluation methods, 3rd edn, Sage, Thousand Oaks, California. Payne, A. (ed) 1995, Advances in relationship marketing, Kogan Page, London. Payne, A. & Holt, S. 2001, 'Diagnosing customer value: Integrating the value process and relationship marketing', British Journal of Management, vol. 12, pp. 159-82. Pecotich, A., Hattie, J. & Low, L. 1999, 'Development of industruct: A scale for the measurement of perceptions of industry structure', Marketing Letters, vol. 10, no. 4, pp. 403-16. Perry, C. 1998, 'A structured approach to presenting research theses', Australasian Marketing Journal, vol. 6, no. 1, pp. 63-86. Peter, J. P. & Donnelly, J. H. 2003, A preface to marketing management, 9th edn, McGraw Hill, New York. Pettigrew, A. M. 1973, The politics of organizational decision making, Tavistock Publications, London. Pfeffer, J. & Salancik, G. R. 1978, The external control of organizations, Harper & Rowe, New York. Phillips, E. M. & Pugh, D. S. 1987, How to get a PhD, Open University Press, Milton Keynes. Pitt, L. F. & Morris, M. H. 1995, 'When marketing and strategy become one', Journal of General Management, vol. 21, no. 2, pp. 21-30. 242 Podsakoff, P. M., MacKenzie, S. B., Lee, J. Y. & Podsakoff, N. P. 2003, 'Common method biases in behavioral research: A critical review of the literature and recommended remedies', Journal of Applied Psychology, vol. 88, no. 5, pp. 879-903. Popper, K. R. 2002, Conjectures and refutations: The growth of scientific knowledge, Harper and Row, New York. Porter, M. E. 1985, 'Generic competition strategies', in Competitive advantage, ed M.E. Porter, Free Press, New York. Porter, M. E. 1986, 'Changing patterns of international competition', California Management Review, vol. 28, no. 2, pp. 9-37. Porter, M. E. 1990a, 'The competitive advantage of firms in global industries', in The competitive advantage of nations, Macmillan Press, London, pp. 40-8. Porter, M. E. 1990b, The competitive advantages of nations, Free Press, New York. Porter, M. E. 1996, 'What is strategy?', Harvard Business Review, vol. 74, no. 6, pp. 61-78. Porter, M. E. 1998, 'The Adam Smith address: Location, clusters and the "New" microeconomics of competition', in 39th Annual Meeting of NABE, New Orleans. Posner, M. 1961, 'International trade and technical change', Oxford Economics Papers, vol. 13, no. 3, pp. 323-41. Prahalad, C. K. & Hamel, G. 1990, 'The core competence of the corporation', Harvard Business Review, vol. 68, no. 3, pp. 79-91. Pugh, D. 1997, 'Decision-making and organizational design', in Organizational theory: Selected readings, Penguin, p. 208. Punch, K. F. 2003, Survey research: The basics, Sage, Thousand Oaks, California. Quelch, J. A. & Hoff, E. J. 1986, 'Customizing global marketing', Harvard Business Review, vol. 64, no. 3, pp. 59-68. Quinn, J. B. 1980, Strategies for change: Logical incrementalism, R.D. Irwin, Homewood, Illinois. Quinn, J. B. 1982, 'Managing strategy incrementally', OMEGA International Journal of Management Science, vol. 10, no. 6, pp. 613-27. Rahman, S. H. 2001, 'The international market selection process: A study of successful Australian international firms', Journal of International Marketing and Exporting, vol. 6, no. 2, pp. 150 - 60. 243 Rahman, S. H. 2006, 'International market selection process: An investigation of the relevance of business operating environment', Journal of International Business Research, vol. 5, no. 1, pp. 73 - 86. Ricardo, D. 1963, The principles of political economy and taxation, Irwin, Homewood, Illinois. Ridderstrale, J. & Nordstrom, K. 2008, Funky business forever, 3rd edn, Financial Times Management, London. Rivera-Batiz, F. & Rivera-Batiz, L. 1994, International finance and open economy macroeconomics, 2nd edn, Macmillan, New York. Robbins, S., Bergman, R., Stagg, I. & Coulter, M. 2006, Management, 4th edn, Pearson Education, Frenchs Forest, New South Wales. Rodrik, D. 2000, 'How far will international economic integration go?', The Journal of Economic Perspectives, vol. 14, no. 1, pp. 177-86. Root, F. R. 1998, Entry strategies for international markets, Lexington Books, Lexington, Massachusetts. Roscoe, J. T. 2004, Fundamental research statistics for the behavioral sciences, 2nd edn, Holt, Rinehart and Winston, New York. Ross, S., Westerfield, R. & Jaffe, J. 2005, Corporate Finance, 7th edn, McGraw-Hill. Roth, K. 1992, 'International configuration and coordination archetypes for medium-sized firms in global industries', Journal of International Business Studies, vol. 23, no. 3, pp. 533-49. Roth, K., Schweiger, D. M. & Morrison, A. J. 1991, 'Global strategy implementation at the business unit level: Operational capabilities and administrative mechanisms', Journal of International Business Studies, vol. 22, no. 3, pp. 369-402. Rowe, A. J., Dickel, K. E., Mason, R. O. & Snyder, N. H. 1993, Strategic management: A methodological approach, 4th edn, Addison-Wesley, New York. Ruekert, R. W. & Walker, O. C., Jr. 1987, 'Marketing's interaction with other functional units: A conceptual framework and empirical evidence', Journal of Marketing, vol. 51, no. 1, pp. 1-19. Rugimbana, R. & Nwankwo, S. 2003, Cross-cultural marketing, Nelson Thomson Learning, Melbourne. Rugman, A. 1997, The theory of multinational enterprises E. Elgar, Brookfield, Vermont 244 Rust, R., Zeithaml, V. & Lemon, K. 2000, Driving customer equity: How customer lifetime value is reshaping corporate strategy, Free Press, New York. Rutenberg, D. P. 1982, Multinational management, Little Brown & Company, Boston. Ryans, J. K., Jr., Griffith, D. A. & White, D. S. 2003, 'Standardization/adaptation of international marketing strategy: Necessary conditions for the advancement of knowledge', International Marketing Review, vol. 20, no. 6, pp. 588-603. Sachs, J. & Larrain, F. 2001, Macroeconomics in the global economy, Prentice-Hall, Englewood Cliffs, New Jersey. Salkind, N. J. 2003, Exploring research, 5th edn, Prentice Hall, Upper Saddle River, New Jersey. Samiee, S. & Roth, K. 1992, 'The influence of global marketing standardization on performance', Journal of Marketing, vol. 56, no. 2, pp. 117. Schilit, W. K. 1987, 'An examination of the influence of middle-level managers in formulating and implementing strategic decisions', Journal of Management Studies, vol. 24, no. 3, pp. 271-93. Schlie, E. & Yip, G. 2000, 'Regional follows global: Strategy mixes in the world automotive industry', European Management Journal, vol. 18, no. 4, pp. 34354. Schon, D. A. 1995, The reflective practitioner: How professionals think in action, Temple Smith, London. Schwenk, C. R. & Dalton, D. R. 1991, 'The changing shape of strategic management research', in Advances in strategic management, eds P. Shrivastava, A. Huff and J. Dutton, JAI Press, Greenwich, Connecticut, pp. 277-300. Sekaran, U. 2003, Research methods for business: A skill building approach, 4th (International) edn, John Wiley & Sons, New York. Sheth, J. N. 1986, 'Global markets or global competition?', Journal of Consumer Marketing, vol. 3, no. 2, pp. 9-11. Shrivastava, P. & Grant, J. H. 1985, 'Empirically derived models of strategic decision making processes', Strategic Management Journal, vol. 6, no. 2, pp. 97-113. Simon, H. A. 1955, 'A behavioral model of rational choice', Quarterly Journal of Economics, vol. 69, no. 1, pp. 129-38. 245 Simon, H. A. 1977, The new science of management decision, Prentice Hall, Englewood Cliffs, New Jersey. Simon, H. A. 1986, 'Rationality in psychology and economics', The Journal of Business, vol. 59, no. 4 pt.2, pp. 209-24. Simon, H. A. 1997, Administrative behavior: A study of decision-making process in administrative organizations, 4th edn, Free Press, New York. Slater, S. F. & Narver, J. C. 1994, 'Does competitive environment moderate the market orientation-performance relationship?', Journal of Marketing, vol. 58, no. 1, pp. 46-54. Solberg, C. A. 2000, 'Standardization or adaptation of the international marketing mix: The role of the local subsidiary/representative', Journal of International Marketing, vol. 8, no. 1, pp. 78-98. Spender, J. C. 1989, Industry recipes: The nature and source of managerial judgement, Blackwell, Oxford. Stalk, G., Evans, P. & Shulman, L. E. 1992, 'Competing on capabilities: The new rules of corporate strategy', Harvard Business Review,, vol. 70, no. 2, pp. 57-69. Steenkamp, J. 2001, 'The role of national culture in international marketing research', International Marketing Review, vol. 18, no. 1, pp. 30-44. Steiner, G. A. 1969, Top management planning, Macmillan, New York. Strauss, A. L. 2008, Qualitative analysis for social scientists, Cambridge University Press, Cambridge. Sudharshan, D. 1995, Marketing strategy - Relationships, offerings, timing and resource allocation, Prentice Hall, New Jersey. Szymanski, D. M., Bharadwrj, S. G. & Varadarajan, P. R. 1993, 'Standardization versus adaptation of international marketing strategy: An empirical investigation', Journal of Marketing, vol. 57, no. 4, pp. 1-17. Tabachnick, B. G. & Fidell, L. S. 2007, Using multivariate statistics, 5th edn, Pearson Education Inc., Boston, Masschusett. Tashakkori, A. & Teddlie, C. 2003, Handbook of mixed methods in social and behavioral research, Sage, Thousand Oaks, California. Terpstra, V. & Sarathy, R. 2000, International marketing, 8th edn, The Dryden Press, Orlando, Florida. The new shorter Oxford English dictionary 1993, ed L. Brown, Claredon Press, Oxford. 246 Theodosiou, M. & Leonidou, L. 2003, 'Standardization versus adaptation of international marketing strategy: An integrative assessment of the empirical research ', International Business Review, vol. 12, no. 2, pp. 141-71. Thirkell, P. C. & Ramadhani, D. 1998, 'Export performance: Success determinants for New Zealand manufacturing exporters', European Journal of Marketing, vol. 32, no. 9/10, pp. 813-29. Thompson, A. A., Jr. & Strickland, A. J., III. 2003, Strategic Management: Concepts and cases, 13th edn, Irwin, Chicago, Illinois. Thompson, L. F., Surface, E. A., Martin, D. L. & Sanders, M. G. 2003, 'From paper to pixels: Moving personnel surveys to the Web', Personnel Psychology, vol. 56, no. 1, pp. 197-227. Ticehurst, G. W. & Veal, A. J. 2000, Business research methods: A managerial approach, Pearson Education Australia, French Forest, New South Wales. Tidwell, P., Bell, P. & Jarratt, D. 1996, Qualitative research techniques, Charles Strut University, Wagga Wagga, New South Wales. Tregoe, B. & Zimmerman, J. 1983, Top management strategy: What it is and how to make it work, Touchstone Books, New York. Trice, H. M. & Beyer, J. M. 1985, 'Rites and ceremonials in organizational culture', in Perspectives in organizational sociology: Theory and research ed S.B. Bacharach, JAI Press, Greenwich, Connecticut. Tse, D., Lee, K., Vertinsky, I. & Wehrung, D. 1988, 'Does culture matter? A cross-cultural study of executives' choice, decisiveness, and risk adjustment in international marketing', The Journal of Marketing, vol. 52, no. 4, pp. 81-95. Varadarajan, P. R. & Clark, T. 1994, 'Delineating the scope of corporate, business and marketing strategy', Journal of Business Research, vol. 31, no. 2-3, pp. 93-105. Vernon, R. 1966, 'International investment and international trade in the product cycle', Quarterly Journal of Economics, vol. 80, no. 2, pp. 190-207. Vernon, R. & Kapstain, E. 1991, 'National needs, global resources', Daedalus, vol. 120, no. 4, pp. 1-22. Walters, P. G. 1986, 'International marketing policy: A discussion of the standardization construct and the relevance for corporate policy', Journal of International Business Studies, vol. 17, no. 2, pp. 55-69. Waters, M. 2001, Globalization, 2nd edn, Routledge, New York. Waud, R., Hocking, A., Maxwell, P. & Bonnici, J. 1992, Economics, 2nd edn, Harper Educational Publishers, Sydney. 247 Webster, F. E. 1992, 'The changing role of marketing in the corporation', Journal of Marketing, vol. 56, no. 4, pp. 1-17. Weick, K. E. 1979, The social psychology of organizing, Addison-Wesley, London. Wells, L. T., Jr. 1968, 'A product life cycle model of international trade', Journal of Marketing, vol. 32, no. 3, pp. 1-6. Werner, O. & Schoepfle, G. M. 1987, Systematic fieldworks: Ethographic analysis and data management, Sage, Newbury Park, California. Westley, F. & Mintzberg, H. 1989, 'Visionary leadership and strategic management', Strategic Management Journal, vol. 10, no. S1, pp. 17-32. Wheelan, T. L. & Hunger, J. D. 2007, Strategic management and business policy, 11th edn, Addison Wesley, London. White, M. 2002, A short course in international marketing blunders, World Trade Press, Palo Alto, California. Wills, J., Samli, A. C. & Jacobs, L. 1991, 'Developing global products and marketing strategies: A construct and research agenda', Journal of Academy of Marketing Science, vol. 19, no. 1, pp. 1-10. Wilson, D. C. 1982, 'Electricity and resistance: A case study of innovation and politics', Organization Studies, vol. 3, no. 2, pp. 119-40. Woodruff, R. B. 1997, 'Customer value: The next source for competitive advantage ', Journal of the Academy of Marketing Science, vol. 25, no. 2, pp. 139-53. World Trade Organization 2008, 'International Trade Data: Australia', Geneva. Wright, K. B. 2005, 'Researching Internet-based populations: Advantages and disadvantages of online survey research, online questionnaire authoring software packages, and web survey services', Journal of Computer-Mediated Communciation, vol. 10, no. 3. Yarbough, B. & Yarbough, R. 2005, The world economy: Trade and finance, 7th edn, Harcourt Brace, New York. Yip, G. S. 1989, 'Global strategy: In a world of nations?', Sloan Management Review, vol. 31, no. 1, pp. 29-41. Zikmund, W. G. 2000, Business research methods, 6th edn, Harcourt College Publisher, Fort Worth, Texas. Zikmund, W. G. 2003, Business research methods, 7th edn, South-Western Thomson, Ohio. 248 Zou, S., Andrus, D. M. & Norvell, D. W. 1997, 'Standardization of marketing strategy by firms from a developing country', International Marketing Review, vol. 14, no. 2, pp. 107-23. Zou, S. & Cavusgil, S. 2002, 'The GMS: A broad conceptualization of global marketing strategy and its effect on firm performance', Journal of Marketing, vol. 66, no. 4, pp. 40-56. Zou, S. & Stan, S. 1998, 'The determinants of export performance: A review of the empirical literature between 1987 and 1997', International Marketing Review, vol. 15, no. 5, pp. 333-72. 249 APPENDICES Appendix 1: Australian Export Awards (2007) Selection Criteria Eligibility Applications are invited from any organisation or firm which exports goods and services of predominantly Australian origin. Winners from past years are eligible to apply for the 2007 Export Awards Winners of the six core State Export Award categories will automatically become finalists in the 2007 Australian Export Awards. Please note, there will be no separate application for the Australian Export Awards and Austrade will not accept entries submitted directly and solely for the 2006 Australian Export Awards. To qualify to apply an applicant must: • Earn foreign exchange. • Operate as a separate business if part of a larger organisation. • Produce goods or services with Australian content of at least 50 per cent of the total sales value. • Have been exporting for more than three years with the exception of applicants for the New Exporter Award. Note: Applications will not be accepted from organisations sponsoring State Export Awards or the Australian Export Awards, Winning organisations will be exporters which are corporate role models for the Australian business community. Winners will demonstrate what significantly differentiates their organisation from other Australian exporters in the same business. Judging Criteria An independent panel of judges will base their selections on the following criteria: • • • • • • Level of export sales as a proportion of total sales - the term 'sales' refers to revenue from primary business activity. This figure should not include grants of any nature or extraordinary income not related to sales. Export growth in the last five year period or since the organisation commenced exporting. The quality of the organisation's marketing strategy. Sound capital base with financial resources to support export growth. Internal company organisation to support export activity. Other factors which judges may consider appropriate. 250 The judges' decision is final and no correspondence will be entered into. This application form is also available on computer disk from your State Export Award Organiser. Categories State winners will be selected in each of six core categories. State winners will automatically become finalists in the 2006 Australian Export Awards. One national winner will be selected in each of the six categories. The Australian Exporters of the Year will be selected from six national category winners. Categories are: New Exporter For outstanding export achievement by an organisation which has been exporting manufactured goods or services for three years or less. Small to Medium Manufacturers For outstanding export achievement by a manufacturer with total annual sales of $20 million or less. Large Manufacturers For outstanding export achievement by a manufacturer with total sales of more than $20 million. Mineral Products For outstanding export achievement by an organisation exporting mineral products. Agricultural Products For outstanding export achievement by an organisation exporting agricultural products. Services For outstanding export achievement in a recognised Australian service industry (the achievement must be quantifiable with specific export earnings which are verifiable) Source: Export Education & Training, Austrade (2007) Guidelines for Applicants: Australian Export Awards 251 Appendix 2: Semi-structured Interview Guide Interview Guide Before commencement of the interview, have the informant read through the ‘Information Sheet for the Interview’. Ask informant whether he or she needs any clarifications regarding the ‘Information Sheet for the Interview’. If required, clarify any points raised by the informant. After the details of the ‘Information Sheet for the Interview’ are understood by the informant and before commencement of the interview, the ‘Informed Consent for Interviews’ form needs to be completed. Run through this form with the informant, delete whatever is required and ensure that informant sign this form, preferably with a witness. Following this pre-interview procedure, a brief explanation of the research project is given to the informant and the in-depth interview begins with the following questions: Start with a series of closed-ended questions to ‘warm-up’ the informant: What category of ownership does this business fall into? How long has the business been involved in international markets? Presently, in how many overseas countries are your product/ services been marketed? In addition to exporting, do your firm have other mode of international involvement, like joint venture, direct investment and/or contractual agreement overseas? Can you tell me the approximate international turnover of your business in the last financial year? After these ‘warm-up’ closed ended questions, it is follow by more open-ended questions as follows: As a successful exporter, tell me how does your business develop winning international marketing strategy? Can you tell me some of the factors your business considers in developing successful international marketing strategies? How are these factors integrated into the development process? Do you consider market and industry factors in the domestic market when developing your business international marketing strategy? IF YES, Tell me about some of these domestic market and industry factors that affect your decisions in the development of your business’s international marketing strategy? 252 How these domestic market and industry factors do affects the development of your business’s international marketing strategy? Do you consider market and industry factors in the foreign market when developing your business international marketing strategy? IF YES, Tell me about some of these foreign market and industry factors that affect your decisions in the development of your business’s international marketing strategy? How these foreign market and industry factors do affects the development of your business’s international marketing strategy? Do you consider the firm’s internal factors when developing your business international marketing strategy? IF YES, Tell me what are some of the firm’s internal factors that affect your decisions in the development of your business’s international marketing strategy? How these internal factors do affects the development of your business’s international marketing strategy? Do you consider the foreign environmental factors when developing your business international marketing strategy? IF YES, Tell me what are some of the foreign environmental factors that affect your decisions in the development of your business’s international marketing strategy? How these foreign environmental factors do affects the development of your business’s international marketing strategy? Does private and public support networks in foreign countries affects your decisions in the development of your business’s international marketing strategy? If yes, how do these private and public support networks in foreign countries factors affects the development of your business’s international marketing strategy? Is there any other factors or information you like to contribute on how your business develops winning international marketing strategy? End of Interview After completion of interview, thank the informant for his or her time. Let them know that a summary of the research is available if requested. 253 Appendix 3: Sample Size Decision Table Sample Size for a Given Population Size Source: Adapted from Sekaran (2003, p. 294) 254 Appendix 4: Online Survey Questionnaire 255 256 257 258 259 260 261 Source: Developed for this research http://tinyurl.com/44w6mx 262 Appendix 5: Information Sheet for Survey INFORMATION SHEET FOR THE SURVEY An empirical study on the factors influencing International Marketing Strategy development among successful exporters in Australia My name is Ricky Tang. I am conducting research on the above project through Southern Cross University. You are invited to participate in a study being conducted that seeks to examine the international marketing strategies practices of successful Australian international marketers. The development of international marketing strategy is crucial in the success of any business attempting to market their products and/or services overseas. There are many factors, both internal and external that impact on the decisions on the development of international marketing strategy. This study will examine what factors do successful Australian exporters consider and how are these factors integrated into the development process. This research forms part of my Doctor of Business Administration studies and will be supervised by Dr. Margo Poole. Procedures to be followed The survey should take roughly 10 minutes to complete. Important demographic information will be collected. This will consist of your firm international business experience, turnover, type of company etc. as it is necessary to provide group related statistics. No other personal information will be collected by the researcher. It will be an online survey with the researcher providing a questionnaire and you will be asked to choose an appropriate answer based on your organisation’s practices, rather than what you think should be done. Please click on the following web link to access the survey: http://tinyurl.com/44w6mx Participation is purely voluntary and no financial remuneration or incentive will be offered for taking part in this research. There are no travel expenses, nor are there any costs associated with participation in this research. There is no cost to you apart from your time. However, if requested an executive summary of the findings can be email to you when the study is completed. 263 Possible Discomforts and Risks There are no foreseeable risks or discomforts for these surveys. Responsibilities of the Researcher It is our duty to make sure that any information given by you is protected. Your name and other identifying information will not be attached to data collected. Your name will only be used to facilitate sending the questionnaire to you. Any identifying information will be destroyed after your participation in the study. Responsibilities of the Participant It is your responsibilities to provide one appropriate answer to each question that are based on your organisation’s practices and that you answer all the questions. Freedom of Consent If you decide to participate, you are free to withdraw your consent and to discontinue participation at any time. However, we would appreciate you letting us know your decision. Inquiries This form is yours to keep for future reference. If you have any questions, we expect you to ask us. If you have any additional questions at any time please ask: Researcher: Ricky Tang Graduate College of Management Southern Cross University PO Box 42 Tweed Heads NSW 2485 Supervisor: Dr. Margo Poole Graduate College of Management Southern Cross University PO Box 42 Tweed Heads NSW 2485 Email: [email protected] Phone: 0403771290 Email: [email protected] Phone: 0415758959 The ethical aspects of this study have been approved by the Southern Cross University Human Research Ethics Committee. The Approval Number is ECN-08057. If you have any complaints or reservations about any ethical aspect of your participation in this research, you may contact the Committee through the Ethics Complaints Officer: Ms Sue Kelly Ethics Complaints Officer and Secretary HREC Southern Cross University PO Box 157 Lismore, NSW, 2480 Telephone (02) 6626-9139 or fax (02) 6626-9145 Email: [email protected] All complaints, in the first instance, should be in writing to the above address. All complaints are investigated fully and according to due process under the National Statement and this University. Any complaint you make will be treated in confidence and you will be informed of the outcome. 264 Appendix 6: Introductory email to the Survey Date: 15 July 2008 Re: International Marketing Strategy Research by Southern Cross University An Empirical Study on the Factors influencing International Marketing Strategy Development among successful Exporters in Australia To: The Manager – Export or (International) Marketing Department* Dear Sir/Madam The development of international marketing strategy is crucial in the success of any business attempting to market their products and/or services overseas. There are many factors, both internal and external that impact on the decisions in the development of international marketing strategy. This study will examine what factors do successful Australian exporters consider and how are these factors integrated into the development process. This study covers all Australian Export Awards finalists and winners from 2003 to 2007. As one such organisation, I would appreciate if you could take part in this research which takes no more than 10 minutes of your time, yet the findings of this study could benefit your organisation and others leading to increase in exports for Australia. You can access the online survey for this research at this web link: http://tinyurl.com/44w6mx Attached is an Information Sheet on the details regarding this research project for your perusal and if requested, an executive summary of the findings can be email to you when completed. I wish to take this opportunity to thank you in anticipation of your kind co-operation. Regards, Ricky Tang, Researcher Graduate College of Management Southern Cross University, Australia * If your organisation does not have an export or (international) marketing department, could the managing director, general manager or someone with in-depth knowledge of the firm's exporting activities complete the questionnaire. Encl: Survey Information Sheet 265 Appendix 7: Follow-up email to the Cover Letter Date: 18 July 2008 Re: International Marketing Strategy Research by Southern Cross University An Empirical Study on the Factors influencing International Marketing Strategy Development among successful Exporters in Australia To: The Manager – Export or (International) Marketing Department* Dear Sir/Madam Further to our recent email dated 15 July 2008 inviting your participation on the above study. It will be greatly appreciated if you could take part in this research which takes no more than 10 minutes of your time, yet the findings of this study could benefit your organisation and others leading to increase in exports for Australia. Please complete the online survey for this research by clicking on this web link: http://tinyurl.com/44w6mx and if requested, an executive summary of the findings can be email to you when completed. Look forward to your response. Thanks in advance. Ricky Tang, Researcher Graduate College of Management Southern Cross University Australia * If your organisation does not have an export or (international) marketing department, could the managing director, general manager or someone with in-depth knowledge of the firm's exporting activities complete the questionnaire. PLEASE IGNORE THIS EMAIL IF YOU HAVE RESPONDED TO THE SURVEY 266 Appendix 8: Email reminder to the Survey Date: 22 July 2008 Re: International Marketing Strategy Research by Southern Cross University An Empirical Study on the Factors influencing International Marketing Strategy Development among successful Exporters in Australia To: The Manager – Export or (International) Marketing Department* Dear Sir/Madam Our recent emails dated 15 July 2008 and 18 July 2008 inviting your participation on the above study refers. It will be greatly appreciated if you could take part in this research which takes no more than 10 minutes of your time, yet the findings of this study could benefit your organisation and others leading to increase in exports for Australia. Please complete the online survey for this research by clicking on this web link: http://tinyurl.com/44w6mx and if requested, an executive summary of the findings can be email to you when completed. Look forward to your response. Thanks in advance. Ricky Tang, Researcher Graduate College of Management Southern Cross University Australia * If your organisation does not have an export or (international) marketing department, could the managing director, general manager or someone with in-depth knowledge of the firm's exporting activities complete the questionnaire. PLEASE IGNORE THIS EMAIL IF YOU HAVE RESPONDED TO THE SURVEY 267 Appendix 9: Second Email Reminder Date: 29 July 2008 Re: International Marketing Strategy Research by Southern Cross University An Empirical Study on the Factors influencing International Marketing Strategy Development among successful Exporters in Australia To: The Manager – Export or (International) Marketing Department* Dear Sir/Madam Further to our emails dated 18 and 22 July 2008 inviting your participation on the above study, it will be greatly appreciated if you could take part in this research. It takes no more than 10 minutes of your time, yet the findings of this study could benefit your organisation and others leading to increase in exports for Australia. Please complete the online survey for this research by clicking on this web link: http://tinyurl.com/44w6mx and if requested, an executive summary of the findings can be email to you when completed. Look forward to your response. Thanks in advance. Ricky Tang, Researcher Graduate College of Management Southern Cross University Australia * If your organisation does not have an export or (international) marketing department, could the managing director, general manager or someone with in-depth knowledge of the firm's exporting activities complete the questionnaire. PLEASE IGNORE THIS EMAIL IF YOU HAVE RESPONDED TO THE SURVEY 268 Appendix 10: SPSS Generated Outputs Frequencies Market Factors in Domestic Markets Valid 3.25 3.50 3.75 4.00 4.25 4.50 4.75 5.00 5.25 5.50 Total Frequency 7 3 2 6 8 4 9 4 4 1 48 Percent 14.6 6.3 4.2 12.5 16.7 8.3 18.8 8.3 8.3 2.1 100.0 Valid Percent 14.6 6.3 4.2 12.5 16.7 8.3 18.8 8.3 8.3 2.1 100.0 Cumulativ e Percent 14.6 20.8 25.0 37.5 54.2 62.5 81.3 89.6 97.9 100.0 Industry Factors in Domestic Markets Valid 3.25 3.50 3.75 4.00 4.25 4.50 4.75 5.00 5.50 Total Frequency 6 6 2 4 9 9 9 2 1 48 Percent 12.5 12.5 4.2 8.3 18.8 18.8 18.8 4.2 2.1 100.0 Valid Percent 12.5 12.5 4.2 8.3 18.8 18.8 18.8 4.2 2.1 100.0 269 Cumulativ e Percent 12.5 25.0 29.2 37.5 56.3 75.0 93.8 97.9 100.0 Market Factors in Foreign Markets Valid 2.75 3.25 3.50 3.75 4.00 4.25 4.50 4.75 5.00 5.25 5.50 5.75 Total Frequency 1 5 8 6 3 7 10 4 1 1 1 1 48 Percent 2.1 10.4 16.7 12.5 6.3 14.6 20.8 8.3 2.1 2.1 2.1 2.1 100.0 Valid Percent 2.1 10.4 16.7 12.5 6.3 14.6 20.8 8.3 2.1 2.1 2.1 2.1 100.0 Cumulativ e Percent 2.1 12.5 29.2 41.7 47.9 62.5 83.3 91.7 93.8 95.8 97.9 100.0 Industry Factors in Foreign Markets Valid 3.00 3.25 3.50 3.75 4.00 4.25 4.50 4.75 5.00 5.25 Total Frequency 3 5 3 6 5 10 3 6 5 2 48 Percent 6.3 10.4 6.3 12.5 10.4 20.8 6.3 12.5 10.4 4.2 100.0 Valid Percent 6.3 10.4 6.3 12.5 10.4 20.8 6.3 12.5 10.4 4.2 100.0 Cumulativ e Percent 6.3 16.7 22.9 35.4 45.8 66.7 72.9 85.4 95.8 100.0 Firm's Internal Factors Valid 3.20 3.40 3.80 4.00 4.20 4.40 4.60 4.80 5.00 5.20 5.40 5.60 Total Frequency 1 1 2 6 6 10 3 7 6 3 1 2 48 Percent 2.1 2.1 4.2 12.5 12.5 20.8 6.3 14.6 12.5 6.3 2.1 4.2 100.0 Valid Percent 2.1 2.1 4.2 12.5 12.5 20.8 6.3 14.6 12.5 6.3 2.1 4.2 100.0 270 Cumulativ e Percent 2.1 4.2 8.3 20.8 33.3 54.2 60.4 75.0 87.5 93.8 95.8 100.0 Foreign Environment Factors Valid 3.00 3.20 3.40 3.60 3.80 4.00 4.20 4.40 4.60 4.80 5.00 5.20 5.40 Total Frequency 2 1 4 4 2 6 7 6 3 9 1 1 2 48 Percent 4.2 2.1 8.3 8.3 4.2 12.5 14.6 12.5 6.3 18.8 2.1 2.1 4.2 100.0 Valid Percent 4.2 2.1 8.3 8.3 4.2 12.5 14.6 12.5 6.3 18.8 2.1 2.1 4.2 100.0 Cumulativ e Percent 4.2 6.3 14.6 22.9 27.1 39.6 54.2 66.7 72.9 91.7 93.8 95.8 100.0 Support Networks Factors in Foreign Markets Valid 2.50 3.00 3.25 3.75 4.00 4.25 4.50 4.75 5.00 5.25 5.50 5.75 6.25 Total Frequency 1 2 2 12 6 3 4 7 3 3 2 2 1 48 Percent 2.1 4.2 4.2 25.0 12.5 6.3 8.3 14.6 6.3 6.3 4.2 4.2 2.1 100.0 Valid Percent 2.1 4.2 4.2 25.0 12.5 6.3 8.3 14.6 6.3 6.3 4.2 4.2 2.1 100.0 271 Cumulativ e Percent 2.1 6.3 10.4 35.4 47.9 54.2 62.5 77.1 83.3 89.6 93.8 97.9 100.0 IMS Development Decisions Valid Frequency 3 3 6 6 6 3 9 5 2 5 48 3.00 3.25 3.50 3.75 4.00 4.25 4.50 4.75 5.00 5.25 Total Percent 6.3 6.3 12.5 12.5 12.5 6.3 18.8 10.4 4.2 10.4 100.0 Valid Percent 6.3 6.3 12.5 12.5 12.5 6.3 18.8 10.4 4.2 10.4 100.0 Cumulativ e Percent 6.3 12.5 25.0 37.5 50.0 56.3 75.0 85.4 89.6 100.0 Factor Analysis Market Factors in Domestic Markets KMO and Bartl ett's Test Kaiser-Mey er-Olkin Measure of Sampling Adequacy . Bart lett 's Test of Sphericity .685 Approx. Chi-Square df Sig. 40.611 6 .000 Total Variance Explained Component 1 2 3 4 Total 2.227 .742 .661 .370 Initial Eigenv alues % of Variance Cumulat iv e % 55.674 55.674 18.548 74.222 16.525 90.747 9.253 100.000 Extract ion Method: Principal Component Analy sis. Component Matri xa Mkt Mkt Mkt Mkt Domestic Domestic Domestic Domestic 1 2 3 4 Component 1 .829 .769 .681 .696 Extraction Method: Principal Component Analy sis. a. 1 components extract ed. 272 Extract ion Sums of Squared Loadings Total % of Variance Cumulat iv e % 2.227 55.674 55.674 Industry Factors in Domestic Markets KMO and Bartl ett's Test Kaiser-Mey er-Olkin Measure of Sampling Adequacy . Bart lett 's Test of Sphericity .721 Approx. Chi-Square df Sig. 35.218 6 .000 Total Variance Explained Component 1 2 3 4 Total 2.171 .771 .615 .442 Initial Eigenv alues % of Variance Cumulat iv e % 54.271 54.271 19.287 73.558 15.381 88.939 11.061 100.000 Extract ion Sums of Squared Loadings Total % of Variance Cumulat iv e % 2.171 54.271 54.271 Extract ion Method: Principal Component Analy sis. Component Matri xa Ind Domestic Ind Domestic Ind Domestic Ind Domestic Component 1 .618 .792 .719 .803 1 2 3 4 Extraction Method: Principal Component Analy sis. a. 1 components extract ed. Market Factors in Foreign Markets KMO and Bartl ett's Test Kaiser-Mey er-Olkin Measure of Sampling Adequacy . Bart lett 's Test of Sphericity .778 Approx. Chi-Square df Sig. 55.711 6 .000 Total Variance Explained Component 1 2 3 4 Total 2.501 .641 .494 .364 Initial Eigenv alues % of Variance Cumulat iv e % 62.513 62.513 16.019 78.532 12.356 90.888 9.112 100.000 Extract ion Method: Principal Component Analy sis. 273 Extract ion Sums of Squared Loadings Total % of Variance Cumulat iv e % 2.501 62.513 62.513 Component Matri xa Mkt Mkt Mkt Mkt Component 1 .715 .764 .847 .829 Foreign 1 Foreign 2 Foreign 3 Foreign 4 Extraction Method: Principal Component Analy sis. a. 1 components extract ed. Industry Factors in Foreign Markets KMO and Bartl ett's Test Kaiser-Mey er-Olkin Measure of Sampling Adequacy . Bart lett 's Test of Sphericity .756 Approx. Chi-Square df Sig. 39.778 6 .000 Total Variance Explained Component 1 2 3 4 Total 2.282 .701 .540 .476 Initial Eigenv alues % of Variance Cumulat iv e % 57.055 57.055 17.532 74.587 13.512 88.098 11.902 100.000 Extract ion Method: Principal Component Analy sis. Component Matri xa Ind Foreign Ind Foreign Ind Foreign Ind Foreign 1 2 3 4 Component 1 .762 .760 .685 .809 Extraction Method: Principal Component Analy sis. a. 1 components extract ed. 274 Extract ion Sums of Squared Loadings Total % of Variance Cumulat iv e % 2.282 57.055 57.055 Firm’s Internal Factors KMO and Bartl ett's Test Kaiser-Mey er-Olkin Measure of Sampling Adequacy . Bart lett 's Test of Sphericity .683 Approx. Chi-Square df Sig. 35.793 10 .000 Total Variance Explained Component 1 2 3 4 5 Total 2.157 1.100 .647 .642 .454 Initial Eigenv alues % of Variance Cumulat iv e % 43.136 43.136 22.008 65.144 12.939 78.084 12.838 90.922 9.078 100.000 Extraction Sums of Squared Loadings Total % of Variance Cumulat iv e % 2.157 43.136 43.136 1.100 22.008 65.144 Extraction Method: Principal Component Analy sis. Component Matri xa Component 1 Firm's Firm's Firm's Firm's Firm's I nt ernal I nt ernal I nt ernal I nt ernal I nt ernal 1 2 3 4 5 2 .919 .784 .758 .645 .714 -.425 Extraction Method: Principal Component Analy sis. a. 2 components extract ed. Rotated Component Matrixa Component 1 Firm's Firm's Firm's Firm's Firm's Int ernal Int ernal Int ernal Int ernal Int ernal 1 2 3 4 5 .721 .762 .714 .712 2 .942 .396 Extraction Method: Principal Component Analy sis. Rotation Met hod: Varimax with Kaiser Normalization. a. Rotation conv erged in 3 iterations. Component Transformation Matrix Component 1 2 1 .982 -.191 2 .191 .982 Extraction Method: Principal Component Analy sis. Rotation Met hod: Varimax wit h Kaiser Normalization. 275 Rotation Sums of Squared Loadings Total % of Variance Cumulat iv e % 2.118 42.363 42.363 1.139 22.782 65.144 Firm’s Internal Factors (revised) KMO and Bartl ett's Test Kaiser-Mey er-Olkin Measure of Sampling Adequacy . Bart lett 's Test of Sphericity .741 Approx. Chi-Square df Sig. 30.961 6 .000 Total Variance Explained Component 1 2 3 4 Total 2.134 .705 .642 .519 Initial Eigenv alues % of Variance Cumulat iv e % 53.352 53.352 17.619 70.971 16.049 87.020 12.980 100.000 Extract ion Method: Principal Component Analy sis. Component Matri xa Firm's Firm's Firm's Firm's I nt ernal I nt ernal I nt ernal I nt ernal 2 3 4 5 Component 1 .764 .767 .670 .716 Extraction Method: Principal Component Analy sis. a. 1 components extract ed. Foreign Environment Factors KMO and Bartl ett's Test Kaiser-Mey er-Olkin Measure of Sampling Adequacy . Bart lett 's Test of Sphericity Approx. Chi-Square df Sig. .712 54.625 10 .000 276 Extract ion Sums of Squared Loadings Total % of Variance Cumulat iv e % 2.134 53.352 53.352 Total Variance Explained Component 1 2 3 4 5 Total 2.520 .908 .661 .573 .338 Initial Eigenv alues % of Variance Cumulat iv e % 50.399 50.399 18.157 68.556 13.213 81.769 11.469 93.239 6.761 100.000 Extract ion Sums of Squared Loadings Total % of Variance Cumulat iv e % 2.520 50.399 50.399 Extract ion Method: Principal Component Analy sis. Component Matri xa Env ironment Env ironment Env ironment Env ironment Env ironment Component 1 .617 .714 .709 .680 .814 1 2 3 4 5 Extraction Method: Principal Component Analy sis. a. 1 components extract ed. Support Networks Factors in Foreign Markets KMO and Bartl ett's Test Kaiser-Mey er-Olkin Measure of Sampling Adequacy . Bart lett 's Test of Sphericity .787 Approx. Chi-Square df Sig. 60.850 6 .000 Total Variance Explained Component 1 2 3 4 Total 2.571 .622 .448 .359 Initial Eigenv alues % of Variance Cumulat iv e % 64.267 64.267 15.548 79.816 11.207 91.022 8.978 100.000 Extract ion Method: Principal Component Analy sis. 277 Extract ion Sums of Squared Loadings Total % of Variance Cumulat iv e % 2.571 64.267 64.267 Component Matri xa Support Support Support Support 1 2 3 4 Component 1 .754 .853 .840 .754 Extraction Method: Principal Component Analy sis. a. 1 components extract ed. IMS Development Decisions Effectiveness KMO and Bartl ett's Test Kaiser-Mey er-Olkin Measure of Sampling Adequacy . Bart lett 's Test of Sphericity .625 Approx. Chi-Square df Sig. 100.245 6 .000 Total Variance Explained Component 1 2 3 4 Total 2.467 .902 .542 .089 Initial Eigenv alues % of Variance Cumulat iv e % 61.687 61.687 22.549 84.236 13.548 97.784 2.216 100.000 Extract ion Method: Principal Component Analy sis. Component Matri xa IMS decisions IMS decisions IMS decisions IMS decisions 1 2 3 4 Component 1 .896 .720 .898 .583 Extraction Method: Principal Component Analy sis. a. 1 components extract ed. 278 Extract ion Sums of Squared Loadings Total % of Variance Cumulat iv e % 2.467 61.687 61.687 Correlation Analysis Market Factors in Domestic Markets Correlati ons Market Factors in Domest ic Market s Mkt Domest ic 1 Mkt Domest ic 2 Mkt Domest ic 3 Mkt Domest ic 4 Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Market Factors in Domest ic Mkt Mkt Mkt Mkt Markets Domest ic 1 Domest ic 2 Domest ic 3 Domest ic 4 1 .800** .734** .735** .704** . .000 .000 .000 .000 48 48 48 48 48 .800** 1 .585** .452** .374** .000 . .000 .001 .009 48 48 48 48 48 .734** .585** 1 .275 .389** .000 .000 . .059 .006 48 48 48 48 48 .735** .452** .275 1 .359* .000 .001 .059 . .012 48 48 48 48 48 .704** .374** .389** .359* 1 .000 .009 .006 .012 . 48 48 48 48 48 **. Correlat ion is signif icant at the 0. 01 lev el (2-tailed). *. Correlat ion is signif icant at the 0. 05 lev el (2-tailed). Industry Factors in Domestic Markets Correlati ons Indust ry Factors in Pears on C orrelation Domest ic Market s Sig. (2-t ailed) N Ind Domest ic 1 Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Ind Domest ic 2 Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Ind Domest ic 3 Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Ind Domest ic 4 Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Indust ry Factors in Domest ic Ind Ind Ind Ind Markets Domest ic 1 Domest ic 2 Domest ic 3 Domest ic 4 1 .659** .781** .721** .776** . .000 .000 .000 .000 48 48 48 48 48 .659** 1 .368** .270 .296* .000 . .010 .064 .041 48 48 48 48 48 .781** .368** 1 .378** .532** .000 .010 . .008 .000 48 48 48 48 48 .721** .270 .378** 1 .467** .000 .064 .008 . .001 48 48 48 48 48 .776** .296* .532** .467** 1 .000 .041 .000 .001 . 48 48 48 48 48 **. Correlat ion is signif icant at the 0. 01 lev el (2-tailed). *. Correlat ion is signif icant at the 0. 05 lev el (2-tailed). 279 Market Factors in Foreign Markets Correlati ons Market Factors in Foreign Market s Mkt Foreign 1 Mkt Foreign 2 Mkt Foreign 3 Mkt Foreign 4 Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Market Factors in Foreign Markets Mkt Foreign 1 Mkt Foreign 2 Mkt Foreign 3 Mkt Foreign 4 1 .738** .766** .837** .816** . .000 .000 .000 .000 48 48 48 48 48 .738** 1 .374** .457** .482** .000 . .009 .001 .001 48 48 48 48 48 .766** .374** 1 .559** .488** .000 .009 . .000 .000 48 48 48 48 48 .837** .457** .559** 1 .622** .000 .001 .000 . .000 48 48 48 48 48 .816** .482** .488** .622** 1 .000 .001 .000 .000 . 48 48 48 48 48 **. Correlat ion is signif icant at the 0. 01 lev el (2-tailed). Industry Factors in Foreign Markets Correlati ons Indust ry Factors in Pears on C orrelation Foreign Market s Sig. (2-t ailed) N Ind Foreign 1 Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Ind Foreign 2 Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Ind Foreign 3 Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Ind Foreign 4 Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Indust ry Factors in Foreign Markets Ind Foreign 1 Ind Foreign 2 Ind Foreign 3 Ind Foreign 4 1 .760** .766** .696** .795** . .000 .000 .000 .000 48 48 48 48 48 .760** 1 .465** .355* .470** .000 . .001 .013 .001 48 48 48 48 48 .766** .465** 1 .325* .492** .000 .001 . .024 .000 48 48 48 48 48 .696** .355* .325* 1 .447** .000 .013 .024 . .001 48 48 48 48 48 .795** .470** .492** .447** 1 .000 .001 .000 .001 . 48 48 48 48 48 **. Correlat ion is signif icant at the 0. 01 lev el (2-tailed). *. Correlat ion is signif icant at the 0. 05 lev el (2-tailed). 280 New Firm’s Internal Factors Correlati ons New Firm's Internal Factors Firm's Int ernal 2 Firm's Int ernal 3 Firm's Int ernal 4 Firm's Int ernal 5 Pears on Correlation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Pears on Correlation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Pears on Correlation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Pears on Correlation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Pears on Correlation Sig. (2-t ailed) N New Firm's Internal Firm's Firm's Firm's Firm's Factors Internal 2 Internal 3 Internal 4 Internal 5 1 .753** .757** .687** .721** . .000 .000 .000 .000 48 48 48 48 48 .753** 1 .479** .344* .375** .000 . .001 .017 .009 48 48 48 48 48 .757** .479** 1 .333* .390** .000 .001 . .021 .006 48 48 48 48 48 .687** .344* .333* 1 .338* .000 .017 .021 . .019 48 48 48 48 48 .721** .375** .390** .338* 1 .000 .009 .006 .019 . 48 48 48 48 48 **. Correlat ion is signif icant at the 0. 01 lev el (2-t ailed). *. Correlat ion is signif icant at the 0. 05 lev el (2-t ailed). Foreign Environment Factors Correlati ons Foreign Env ironment Factors Env ironment 1 Env ironment 2 Env ironment 3 Env ironment 4 Env ironment 5 Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Foreign Env ironment Factors Env ironment 1 Env ironment 2 Env ironment 3 Env ironment 4 Env ironment 5 1 .654** .713** .687** .684** .800** . .000 .000 .000 .000 .000 48 48 48 48 48 48 .654** 1 .433** .158 .286* .396** .000 . .002 .285 .049 .005 48 48 48 48 48 48 .713** .433** 1 .349* .366* .396** .000 .002 . .015 .011 .005 48 48 48 48 48 48 .687** .158 .349* 1 .358* .600** .000 .285 .015 . .013 .000 48 48 48 48 48 48 .684** .286* .366* .358* 1 .419** .000 .049 .011 .013 . .003 48 48 48 48 48 48 .800** .396** .396** .600** .419** 1 .000 .005 .005 .000 .003 . 48 48 48 48 48 48 **. Correlat ion is signif icant at the 0. 01 lev el (2-t ailed). *. Correlat ion is signif icant at the 0. 05 lev el (2-t ailed). 281 Support Networks Factors in Foreign Markets Correlati ons Support Network s Fact ors Pears on Correlation in Foreign Markets Sig. (2-t ailed) N Support 1 Pears on Correlation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Support 2 Pears on Correlation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Support 3 Pears on Correlation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Support 4 Pears on Correlation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Support Net works Factors in Foreign Markets Support 1 Support 2 Support 3 Support 4 1 .776** .842** .834** .749** . .000 .000 .000 .000 48 48 48 48 48 .776** 1 .514** .542** .386** .000 . .000 .000 .007 48 48 48 48 48 .842** .514** 1 .631** .559** .000 .000 . .000 .000 48 48 48 48 48 .834** .542** .631** 1 .495** .000 .000 .000 . .000 48 48 48 48 48 .749** .386** .559** .495** 1 .000 .007 .000 .000 . 48 48 48 48 48 **. Correlat ion is signif icant at the 0. 01 lev el (2-t ailed). IMS Development Decisions Effectiveness Correlati ons IMS D ev elopment Dec is ions IMS decisions 1 IMS decisions 2 IMS decisions 3 IMS decisions 4 Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N Pears on C orrelation Sig. (2-t ailed) N IMS Dev elopment IMS IMS IMS IMS Dec is ions dec isions 1 dec isions 2 dec isions 3 dec isions 4 1 .861** .754** .866** .631** . .000 .000 .000 .000 48 48 48 48 48 .861** 1 .459** .910** .287* .000 . .001 .000 .048 48 48 48 48 48 .754** .459** 1 .438** .431** .000 .001 . .002 .002 48 48 48 48 48 .866** .910** .438** 1 .321* .000 .000 .002 . .026 48 48 48 48 48 .631** .287* .431** .321* 1 .000 .048 .002 .026 . 48 48 48 48 48 **. Correlat ion is signif icant at the 0. 01 lev el (2-t ailed). *. Correlat ion is signif icant at the 0. 05 lev el (2-t ailed). 282 Explore Market Factors in Domestic Markets 5.50 5.00 4.50 4.00 3.50 3.00 Market Factors in Domestic Markets Industry Factors in Domestic Markets 5.50 5.00 4.50 4.00 3.50 3.00 Industry Factors in Domestic Markets 283 Market Factors in Foreign Markets 6.00 5.50 5.00 4.50 4.00 3.50 3.00 2.50 Market Factors in Foreign Markets Industry Factors in Foreign Markets 5.50 5.00 4.50 4.00 3.50 3.00 Industry Factors in Foreign Markets 284 Firm’s Internal Factors 6.00 5.50 5.00 4.50 4.00 3.50 3.00 Firm's Internal Factors Foreign Environment Factors 5.50 5.00 4.50 4.00 3.50 3.00 Foreign Environment Factors 285 Support Networks Factors in Foreign Markets 6.00 5.00 4.00 3.00 Support Networks Factors in Foreign Markets IMS Development Decisions Effectiveness 5.50 5.00 4.50 4.00 3.50 3.00 IMS Development Decisions 286 Descriptives Descriptive Statistics N St at ist ic Market Fact ors in Domestic Markets Industry Factors in Domestic Markets Market Fact ors in Foreign Markets Industry Factors in Foreign Markets Firm's Int ernal Factors Foreign Env ironment Factors Support Net works Factors in Foreign Markets IMS Dev elopment Decisions Valid N (listwise) Skewness St at ist ic St d. Error Kurt osis St at ist ic St d. Error 48 -.184 .343 -.945 .674 48 -.221 .343 -.763 .674 48 .319 .343 -.103 .674 48 -.098 .343 -.916 .674 48 -.090 .343 .020 .674 48 -.149 .343 -.537 .674 48 .200 .343 -.147 .674 48 .013 .343 -.957 .674 48 Descriptives Descriptive Statistics N Market Factors in Domestic Market s Industry Factors in Domestic Market s Market Factors in Foreign Markets Industry Factors in Foreign Markets Foreign Env ironment Factors Support Networks Factors in Foreign Markets IMS Dev elopment Decisions New Firm's I nt ernal Factors Valid N (list wise) Range Minimum Maximum Mean Std. Dev iat ion Variance 48 2.25 3.25 5.50 4.2917 .64892 .421 48 2.25 3.25 5.50 4.1875 .57311 .328 48 3.00 2.75 5.75 4.0990 .64151 .412 48 2.25 3.00 5.25 4.1302 .63579 .404 48 2.40 3.00 5.40 4.2208 .59963 .360 48 3.75 2.50 6.25 4.3229 .79386 .630 48 2.25 3.00 5.25 4.1563 .65968 .435 48 2.25 3.25 5.50 4.3958 .58079 .337 48 287 Frequencies Industries Type Valid High Tech Primary Producers Manuf acturing Serv ices Resources Others Total Frequency 18 4 11 11 3 1 48 Percent 37.5 8.3 22.9 22.9 6.3 2.1 100.0 Cumulat iv e Percent 37.5 45.8 68.8 91.7 97.9 100.0 Valid Percent 37.5 8.3 22.9 22.9 6.3 2.1 100.0 Ownershi p Type Valid Frequency Australian Proprietary Co. 30 Australian Gov t Enterprise 4 Australian Sole Trader / 3 Part nership Subsidiary of Foreign 3 MNC Australian Public Co. 8 Total 48 Percent 62.5 8.3 Valid Percent 62.5 8.3 Cumulat iv e Percent 62.5 70.8 6.3 6.3 77.1 6.3 6.3 83.3 16.7 100.0 16.7 100.0 100.0 Years of International Business Valid Frequency > 3 y ears & < 5 y ears 8 > 5 y ears 40 Total 48 Percent 16.7 83.3 100.0 Valid Percent 16.7 83.3 100.0 Cumulat iv e Percent 16.7 100.0 No. of Overseas Mkts served Valid < 3 countries 4 to 10 countries > 10 countries Total Frequency 3 11 34 48 Percent 6.3 22.9 70.8 100.0 288 Valid Percent 6.3 22.9 70.8 100.0 Cumulat iv e Percent 6.3 29.2 100.0 International Turnover Valid Frequency < A$5.0 M 10 A$5.0 M t o A$50.0 M 32 > A$50.0 M 6 Total 48 Percent 20.8 66.7 12.5 100.0 Valid Percent 20.8 66.7 12.5 100.0 Exporting Valid Yes Frequency 48 Percent 100.0 Valid Percent 100.0 Cumulativ e Percent 100.0 Contractual Agreement Valid No Yes Total Frequency 37 11 48 Percent 77.1 22.9 100.0 Valid Percent 77.1 22.9 100.0 Cumulativ e Percent 77.1 100.0 Joint Venture Valid No Y es Total Frequency 44 4 48 Percent 91.7 8.3 100.0 Valid Percent 91.7 8.3 100.0 Cumulativ e Percent 91.7 100.0 Direct Investment Valid No Y es Total Frequency 40 8 48 Percent 83.3 16.7 100.0 Valid Percent 83.3 16.7 100.0 Cumulativ e Percent 83.3 100.0 Others Valid No Yes Total Frequency 45 3 48 Percent 93.8 6.3 100.0 Valid Percent 93.8 6.3 100.0 289 Cumulativ e Percent 93.8 100.0 Cumulat iv e Percent 20.8 87.5 100.0 Factor Analysis for testing Common Method Variance Total Variance Expl ained Component 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 Tot al 14. 168 3. 813 2. 843 2. 736 2. 171 1. 288 1. 231 1. 071 .781 .627 .565 .455 .394 .322 .311 .236 .178 .146 .127 .112 9. 346E-02 6. 978E-02 5. 961E-02 4. 853E-02 4. 397E-02 3. 607E-02 2. 794E-02 1. 555E-02 1. 193E-02 8. 820E-03 5. 996E-03 3. 361E-03 5. 921E-17 -1.99E-17 Init ial Eigenv alues % of Variance Cumulat iv e % 41. 670 41. 670 11. 215 52. 885 8. 361 61. 246 8. 046 69. 293 6. 384 75. 677 3. 788 79. 465 3. 621 83. 086 3. 150 86. 236 2. 297 88. 533 1. 843 90. 376 1. 662 92. 039 1. 339 93. 378 1. 158 94. 536 .947 95. 482 .916 96. 398 .695 97. 094 .524 97. 618 .429 98. 047 .374 98. 420 .330 98. 750 .275 99. 025 .205 99. 230 .175 99. 405 .143 99. 548 .129 99. 677 .106 99. 784 8. 217E-02 99. 866 4. 572E-02 99. 911 3. 509E-02 99. 947 2. 594E-02 99. 972 1. 764E-02 99. 990 9. 887E-03 100.000 1. 742E-16 100.000 -5.857E-17 100.000 Extraction Sums of Squared Loadings Tot al % of Variance Cumulat iv e % 14. 168 41. 670 41. 670 3. 813 11. 215 52. 885 2. 843 8. 361 61. 246 2. 736 8. 046 69. 293 2. 171 6. 384 75. 677 1. 288 3. 788 79. 465 1. 231 3. 621 83. 086 1. 071 3. 150 86. 236 Extraction Met hod: Principal Component Analy s is . Reliability Market Factors in Domestic Markets Reliabi lity Statisti cs Cronbach's Alpha .725 N of Items 4 Industry Factors in Domestic Markets Reliabi lity Statisti cs Cronbach's Alpha .715 N of Items 4 290 Rot ation Sums of Squared Loadings Tot al % of Variance Cumulat iv e % 6. 346 18. 666 18. 666 5. 028 14. 788 33. 454 4. 701 13. 828 47. 281 3. 502 10. 299 57. 581 3. 343 9. 834 67. 414 2. 687 7. 903 75. 318 2. 423 7. 126 82. 443 1. 290 3. 793 86. 236 Market Factors in Foreign Markets Reliabi lity Statisti cs Cronbach's Alpha .797 N of Items 4 Industry Factors in Foreign Markets Reliabi lity Statisti cs Cronbach's Alpha .747 N of Items 4 Firm’s Internal Factors Reliabi lity Statisti cs Cronbach's Alpha .708 N of Items 4 Foreign Environment Factors Reliabi lity Statisti cs Cronbach's Alpha .751 N of Items 5 Support Networks factors in Foreign Markets Reliabi lity Statisti cs Cronbach's Alpha .812 N of Items 4 291 IMS Development Decisions Effectiveness Reliabi lity Statisti cs Cronbach's Alpha .787 N of Items 4 292 Nonparametric Correlations of Key Variables Correlati ons Spearman's rho IMS Dev elopment Decisions Market Factors in Domestic Market s Industry Factors in Domestic Market s Market Factors in Foreign Markets Industry Factors in Foreign Markets New Firm's I nternal Factors Foreign Env ironment Factors Support Networks Factors in Foreign Markets Correlation Coef f icient Sig. (2-tailed) N Correlation Coef f icient Sig. (2-tailed) N Correlation Coef f icient Sig. (2-tailed) N Correlation Coef f icient Sig. (2-tailed) N Correlation Coef f icient Sig. (2-tailed) N Correlation Coef f icient Sig. (2-tailed) N Correlation Coef f icient Sig. (2-tailed) N Correlation Coef f icient Sig. (2-tailed) N **. Correlation is signif icant at the .01 lev el (2-t ailed). 293 Support Market Industry Market Industry Networks IMS Factors in Factors in Factors in Factors in New Firm's Foreign Factors in Dev elopment Domestic Domestic Foreign Foreign Internal Env ironment Foreign Decisions Markets Markets Markets Markets Factors Factors Markets 1.000 .826** .780** .855** .825** .767** .867** -.073 . .000 .000 .000 .000 .000 .000 .623 48 48 48 48 48 48 48 48 .826** 1.000 .887** .855** .797** .901** .921** .070 .000 . .000 .000 .000 .000 .000 .638 48 48 48 48 48 48 48 48 .780** .887** 1.000 .826** .756** .841** .877** .096 .000 .000 . .000 .000 .000 .000 .515 48 48 48 48 48 48 48 .855** .000 48 .825** .000 48 .767** .000 48 .867** .000 48 -.073 .623 48 .855** .000 48 .797** .000 48 .901** .000 48 .921** .000 48 .070 .638 48 .826** .000 48 .756** .000 48 .841** .000 48 .877** .000 48 .096 .515 48 1.000 . 48 .802** .000 48 .819** .000 48 .886** .000 48 -.066 .658 48 .802** .000 48 1.000 . 48 .710** .000 48 .908** .000 48 .013 .928 48 .819** .000 48 .710** .000 48 1.000 . 48 .854** .000 48 .012 .936 48 .886** .000 48 .908** .000 48 .854** .000 48 1.000 . 48 .030 .841 48 48 -.066 .658 48 .013 .928 48 .012 .936 48 .030 .841 48 1.000 . 48 Regression Model Summary Model 1 R .902a R Square .813 Adjusted R Square .781 Std. Error of the Est imat e .30906 a. Predictors: (Constant), New Firm's Int ernal Factors, Support Networks Factors in Foreign Markets, Indust ry Factors in Foreign Markets, Industry Factors in Domestic Market s, Market Factors in Foreign Markets, Market Factors in Domestic Markets, Foreign Env ironment Factors ANOVAb Model 1 Regression Residual Total Sum of Squares 16.632 3.821 20.453 df 7 40 47 Mean Square 2.376 .096 F 24.876 Sig. .000a a. Predictors: (Constant), New Firm's Internal Factors, Support Networks Factors in Foreign Markets, Industry Factors in Foreign Markets, Indust ry Fact ors in Domestic Markets, Market Factors in Foreign Markets, Market Factors in Domestic Markets, Foreign Env ironment Factors b. Dependent Variable: IMS Dev elopment Decisions Coeffici entsa Model 1 (Constant) Market Factors in Domestic Market s Industry Factors in Domestic Market s Market Factors in Foreign Markets Industry Factors in Foreign Markets Foreign Env ironment Factors Support Networks Factors in Foreign Markets New Firm's I nt ernal Factors Unstandardized Coef f icients B Std. Error .178 .429 Standardized Coef f icients Beta Zero-order Correlations Part ial .415 Sig. .680 t Part .091 .224 .090 .408 .685 .839 .064 .028 .094 .186 .082 .507 .615 .793 .080 .035 .201 .159 .196 1.265 .213 .836 .196 .086 .240 .177 .232 1.357 .182 .838 .210 .093 .310 .291 .282 1.065 .293 .879 .166 .073 -.077 .060 -.093 -1.289 .205 -.045 -.200 -.088 .091 .171 .080 .532 .598 .786 .084 .036 a. Dependent Variable: IMS Dev elopment Decisions 294